63090en Parametros
63090en Parametros
Parameter Manual
                                                     Warning
          Warning notices are used in this publication to emphasize that hazardous voltages, currents,
          temperatures, or other conditions that could cause personal injury exist in this equipment or may
          be associated with its use.
          In situations where inattention could cause either personal injury or damage to equipment, a
          Warning notice is used.
                                                      Caution
          Caution notices are used where equipment might be damaged if care is not taken.
                                                       Note
          Notes merely call attention to information that is especially significant to understanding and
          operating the equipment.
          This document is based on information available at the time of its publication. While efforts
          have been made to be accurate, the information contained herein does not purport to cover all
          details or variations in hardware or software, nor to provide for every possible contingency in
          connection with installation, operation, or maintenance. Features may be described herein which
          are not present in all hardware and software systems. GE Fanuc Automation assumes no
          obligation of notice to holders of this document with respect to changes subsequently made.
PREFACE
                NOTE
                1 For ease of explanation, the models may be classified as
                  follows:
                  T series: 21i–TA/210i–TA/210is–TA
                  M series: 21i–MA/210i–MA/210is–MA
                2 Some functions described in this manual may not be applied
                  to some products.
                  For details, refer to the DESCRIPTIONS (B–63002EN).
                            p–1
            PREFACE                                           B–63090EN/02
The table below lists manuals related to MODEL A of Series 21i, Series
210i, Serries 210is. In the table, this manual is maked with an asterisk (*).
                 p–2
B–63090EN/02                                                                   Table of Contents
   PREFACE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . p–1
1. DISPLAYING PARAMETERS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1
   4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                                                           7
       4.1      PARAMETERS OF SETTING . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                        9
       4.2      PARAMETERS OF READER/PUNCHER INTERFACE, REMOTE BUFFER,
                DNC1, DNC2, AND M–NET INTERFACE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                                   13
               4.2.1       Parameters Common to all Channels . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .        14
               4.2.2       Parameters of Channel 1 (I/O CHANNEL=0) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                15
               4.2.3       Parameters of Channel 1 (I/O CHANNEL=1) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                16
               4.2.4       Parameters of Channel 2 (I/O CHANNEL=2) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                17
               4.2.5       Parameters of Channel 3 (I/O CHANNEL=3) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                17
       4.3      PARAMETERS OF DNC1/DNC2 INTERFACE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                                       20
       4.4      PARAMETERS OF REMOTE DIAGNOSIS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                                    23
       4.5      PARAMETERS OF DNC1 INTERFACE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                                  27
       4.6      PARAMETER OF MEMORY CARD INTERFACE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                                            29
       4.7      PARAMETERS OF FACTOLINK . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                           30
       4.8      PARAMETERS OF DATA SERVER . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                             32
       4.9      PARAMETERS OF ETHERNET . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                          34
       4.10     PARAMETERS OF POWER MATE CNC MANAGER . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                                                35
       4.11     PARAMETERS OF AXIS CONTROL/INCREMENT SYSTEM . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                                                       36
       4.12     PARAMETERS OF COORDINATES . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                               45
       4.13     PARAMETERS OF STROKE CHECK . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                                51
       4.14     PARAMETERS OFTHE CHUCK AND TAILSTOCK BARRIER (T SERIES) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                                                                   56
       4.15     PARAMETERS OF FEEDRATE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                          60
       4.16     PARAMETERS OF ACCELERATION/DECELERATION CONTROL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                                                               71
       4.17     PARAMETERS OF SERVO . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                     87
       4.18     PARAMETERS OF DI/DO . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                  115
       4.19     PARAMETERS OF MDI, DISPLAY, AND EDIT . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                                     119
       4.20     PARAMETERS OF PROGRAMS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                           146
       4.21     PARAMETERS OF PITCH ERROR COMPENSATION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                                               155
       4.22     PARAMETERS OF SPINDLE CONTROL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                                  166
       4.23     PARAMETERS OF TOOL COMPENSATION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                                      207
       4.24     PARAMETERS OF CANNED CYCLES . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                                216
               4.24.1      Parameter of canned Cycle for Drilling . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .    216
               4.24.2      Parameter of Thread Cutting Cycle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   222
               4.24.3      Parameter of Multiple Repetitive Canned Cycle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .           222
               4.24.4      Parameters of Peck Drilling Cycle of a Small Diameter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .               224
       4.25     PARAMETERS OF RIGID TAPPING . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .                            228
                                                                               c–1
                                                                     Table of Contents                                                                      B–63090EN/02
APPENDIX
  A. CHARACTER CODE LIST . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 365
                                                                                c–2
B–63090EN/02                                                                            1. DISPLAYING PARAMETERS
1 DISPLAYING PARAMETERS
         >
         MEM STRT MTN FIN *** 10:02:35
         [PARAM] [DGNOS] [ PMC ] [SYSTEM] [(OPRT)]                                Soft key display
                                                                                  (section select)
                                             (2) The parameter screen consists of multiple pages. Use step (a) or (b)
                                                 to display the page that contains the parameter you want to display.
                                                 (a) Use the page select key or the cursor move keys to display the de-
                                                     sired page.
                                                 (b) Enter the data number of the parameter you want to display from
                                                     the keyboard, then press the [NO.SRH] soft key. The parameter
                                                     page containing the specified data number appears with the cur-
                                                     sor positioned at the data number. (The data is displayed in re-
                                                     verse video.)
                                              NOTE
                                               If key entry is started with the section select soft keys
                                               displayed, they are replaced automatically by operation
                                               select soft keys including [NO.SRH]. Pressing the [(OPRT)]
                                               soft key can also cause the operation select keys to be
                                               displayed.
                                                             1
2. SETTING PARAMETERS FROM MDI                                                          B–63090EN/02
                                 3. Press the [(OPRT)] soft key to display operation select soft keys.
                       >
                       MDI STOP *** *** *** 10:03:02
                                                                                 ← Soft key display
                       [NO.SRH] [ ON:1 ] [ OFF:0 ] [+INPUT] [INPUT]
                                                                                   (section select)
                                              2
B–63090EN/02                                                2. SETTING PARAMETERS FROM MDI
                                  >
                                  MDI STOP *** *** ALM 10:03:10
                                  [NO.SRH] [ ON:1 ] [ OFF:0 ] [+INPUT] [INPUT]
                                              3
3. INPUTTING AND OUTPUTTING PARAMETERS THROUGH
   THE READER/PUNCHER INTERFACE                                                      B–63090EN/02
3 READER/PUNCHER INTERFACE
                                          4
                                   3. INPUTTING AND OUTPUTTING PARAMETERS THROUGH
B–63090EN/02                                          THE READER/PUNCHER INTERFACE
3.1
                           (1) Select the EDIT mode or set to Emergency stop.
OUTPUTTING
                           (2) To select the parameter screen, press the SYSTEM function key as
PARAMETERS                     many times as required, or alternatively press the SYSTEM function
THROUGH THE                    key once, then the PARAM section select soft key.
READER/PUNCHER             (3) Press the [(OPRT)] soft key to display operation select soft keys, then
INTERFACE                      press the forward menu key located at the right–hand side of the soft
                               keys to display another set of operation select keys including
                               PUNCH.
               >
               MDI STOP *** *** ALM 10:03:10                                     State display
                [NO.SRH] [ON:1] [OFF:0] [+INPUT] [INPUT]                         Soft key display
                                                                                 (operation select)
                           (4) Pressing the [PUNCH] soft key changes the soft key display as
                               shown below:
               >
               EDIT STOP *** *** *** 10:35:03
               [      ] [      ] [      ] [CANCEL] [ EXEC ]
                           (5) Press the [EXEC] soft key to start parameter output. When
                               parameters are being output, “OUTPUT” blinks in the state display
                               field on the lower part of the screen.
               >
               EDIT STOP *** *** *** 10:35:04    OUTPUT                    ← OUTPUT blinking
               [      ] [      ] [      ] [CANCEL] [ EXEC ]
                                           5
3. INPUTTING AND OUTPUTTING PARAMETERS THROUGH
   THE READER/PUNCHER INTERFACE                                                         B–63090EN/02
3.2
                           (1) Place the NC in the emergency stop state.
INPUTTING
                           (2) Enable parameter writing.
PARAMETERS
                               1. To display the setting screen, press the SETTING function key
THROUGH THE                       as many times as required, or alternatively press the SETTING
READER/PUNCHER                    function key once, then the SETTING section select soft key. The
                                  first page of the setting screen appears.
INTERFACE
                               2. Position the cursor on “PARAMETER WRITE” using the cursor
                                  move keys.
                               3. Press the [(OPRT)] soft key to display operation select soft keys.
                               4. To set “PARAMETER WRITE=” to 1, press the ON:1 soft key,
                                  or alternatively enter 1, then press the [INPUT] soft key. From
                                  now on, parameters can be set. At the same time an alarm condi-
                                  tion (P/S100 PARAMETER WRITE ENABLE) occurs in the
                                  NC.
                           (3) To select the parameter screen, press the SYSTEM function key as
                               many times as required, or alternatively press the SYSTEM key once,
                               then [PARAM] soft key.
                           (4) Press the [(OPRT)] soft key to display operation select keys, then
                               press the forward menu key located at the right–hand side of the soft
                               keys to display another set of operation select soft keys including
                               [READ].
                   >
                   EDIT STOP –EMS– ALM 10:37:30                            ← State display
                   [      ] [ READ ] [PUNCH] [          ] [        ]       ← Soft key display
                           (5) Pressing the [READ] soft key changes the soft key display as shown
                               below:
                  >
                  EDIT STOP –EMS– ALM 10:37:30
                  [      ] [     ] [      ] [CANCEL] [ EXEC ]
                           (6) Press the [EXEC] soft key to start inputting parameters from the
                               input/output device. When parameters are being input, “INPUT”
                               blinks in the state display field on the lower part of the screen.
                  >
                  EDIT STOP –EMS– ALM 10:37:30    INPUT                  ← INPUT blinking
                  [      ] [     ] [      ] [CANCEL] [ EXEC ]
                           (7) When parameter input terminates, “INPUT” stops blinking. Press the
                               RESET key to interrupt parameter input.
                           (8) When parameter read terminates, “INPUT” stops blinking, and an
                               alarm condition (P/S000) occurs in the NC. Turn it off before
                               continuing operation.
                                           6
B–63090EN/02                                                        4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
4 DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
                                  NOTE
                                  1 For the bit type and bit axis type parameters, a single data
                                    number is assigned to 8 bits. Each bit has a different
                                    meaning.
                                  2 The axis type allows data to be set separately for each
                                    control axis.
                                  3 The valid data range for each data type indicates a general
                                    range. The range varies according to the parameters. For
                                    the valid data range of a specific parameter, see the
                                    explanation of the parameter.
(2) Notation of parameters other than bit type and bit axis type
                                                7
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS                                                                B–63090EN/02
                               NOTE
                               1 The bits left blank in 4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
                                 and parameter numbers that appear on the display but are
                                 not found in the parameter list are reserved for future
                                 expansion. They must always be 0.
                               2 Parameters having different meanings between the T series
                                 and M series and parameters that are valid only for the T or
                                 M series are indicated in two levels as shown below.
                                 Parameters left blank are unavailable.
                                 Example1
                                   Parameter 5010 has different meanings for the T series
                                   and M series.
                                                  Tool nose radius compensation ...             T series
                               5010
                                                      Tool compensation C ...                   M series
                                 Example2
                                  DPI is a parameter common to the M and T series, but GSB
                                  and GSC are parameters valid only for the T series.
                                          #7          #6                              #0
                                         GSC         GSB                              DPI       T series
                               3401
                                                                                      DPI        M series
                                 Example3
                                  The following parameter is provided only for the M series.
                                                                                                T series
                               1450
                                                           F1 digit feed ...                     M series
                                            8
B–63090EN/02                                              4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
4.1                                #7      #6       #5    #4     #3     #2       #1      #0
PARAMETERS OF          0000                        SEQ                  INI     ISO     TVC
SETTING
                           Setting entry is acceptable.
               [Data type] Bit
                    TVC TV check
                        0 : Not performed
                        1 : Performed
                     ISO Code used for data output
                         0 : EIA code
                         1 : ISO code
                     INI Unit of input
                         0 : In mm
                         1 : In inches
                    SEQ Automatic insertion of sequence numbers
                        0: Not performed
                        1: Performed
                              NOTE
                               When a program is prepared by using MDI keys in the part
                               program storage and edit mode, a sequence number can
                               automatically be assigned to each block in set increments.
                               Set the increment to parameter 3216.
                                   #7      #6       #5    #4     #3      #2      #1     #0
                       0001                                                     FCV
                              NOTE
                                Programs created in the Series 10/11 tape format can be
                                used for operation on the following functions:
                                1 Subprogram call M98
                                2 Thread cutting with equal leads G32 (T series)
                                3 Canned cycle G90, G92, G94 (T series)
                                4 Multiple repetitive canned cycle G71 to G76 (T series)
                                5 Drilling canned cycle G73, G74, G76, G80 to G89 (M
                                    series)
                                6 Cutter compensation C (M series)
                                When the tape format used in the Series 10/11 is used for
                                this CNC, some limits may add. Refer to the Series
                                21i/210i–MODEL A OPERATOR’S MANUAL.
                                           9
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS                                                                     B–63090EN/02
                                        #7       #6       #5        #4       #3       #2        #1       #0
                                                                                                        RDG
                           0002
                                       SJZ                                                              RDG
                                  Note
                                    SJZ is enabled when bit 3 (HJZ) of parameter No.1005 is
                                    set to 1. When a reference position is set without a dog,
                                    (i.e. when bit 1 (DLZ) of parameter No.1002 is set to 1 or
                                    bit 1 (DLZx) of parameter No.1005 is set to 1) reference
                                    position return after reference position setting is
                                    performed using rapid traverse at all times, regardless of
                                    the setting of SJZ.
                                       #7        #6       #5       #4        #3       #2        #1       #0
                           0012       RMVx                         AIC                                  MIRx
                                      RMVx                                                              MIRx
                                  NOTE
                                   RMVx is valid when RMBx in parameter 1005#7 is 1.
                                                10
B–63090EN/02                                                                 4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
                                  In addition, data can be transferred to and from the Power Mate via the
                                  FANUC I/O Link.
                                  This parameter selects the interface used to transfer data to and from an
                                  input/output device.
                                      Setting                                    Description
                                       0, 1       RS–232C serial port 1
                                         2        RS–232C serial port 2
                                         3        Remote buffer interface
                                         4        Memory card interface
                                         5        Data server interface
                                         6        The DNC operation is performed or M198 is specified by FOCAS1/
                                                  Ethernet or DNC1/Ethernet.
                                        10        DNC1/DNC2 interface
                                        12        DNC1 interface #2
                                        15        M198 is specified by FOCAS1/HSSB. (Bit 1 (NWD) of parameter
                                                  No. 8706) must also be specified.)
                                        16        The DNC operation is performed or M198 is specified by FOCAS1/
                                                  HSSB (port 2).
                                        20        Group 0
                                        21        Group 1
                                        22        Group 2        Data is transferred between the CNC and a Power
                                         |           |           Mate in group n (n: 0 to 15) via the FANUC I/O Link.
                                        34        Group 14
                                        35        Group 15
                                  Supplemental remark 1
                                       If the DNC operation is performed with FOCAS1/HSSB, the setting
                                       of parameter No. 20 does not matter. The DMMC signal <G042.7>
                                       is used.
                                  Supplemental remark 2
                                       If bit 0 (IO4) of parameter No. 110 is set to control the I/O channels
                                       separately, the I/O channels can be divided into four types: input and
                                       output in the foreground and input and output in the background. If
                                       so, parameter No. 20 becomes a parameter for selecting the input
                                       device in the foreground.
                                                        11
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS                                                                                  B–63090EN/02
 NOTE
 1 An input/output device can also be selected using the setting screen. Usually, the setting screen
   is used.
 2 The specifications (such as the baud rate and the number of stop bits) of the input/output
   devices to be connected must be set in the corresponding parameters for each interface
   beforehand. (See Section 4.2.) I/O CHANNEL = 0 and I/O CHANNEL = 1 represent input/output
   devices connected to RS–232C serial port 1. Separate parameters for the baud rate, stop bits,
   and other specifications are provided for each channel.
             Mother board
                                           NOTE
                                            If different input/output devices are simultaneously used in
                                            the foreground and background, just a value from 0 to 3 can
                                            be specified for the background device.
                                            If an attempt is made to use a busy input/output device, an
                                            alarm (P/S233 or BP/S233) will be raised. Note that the
                                            settings 0 and 1 indicate the same input/output device.
                                                        12
B–63090EN/02                                                              4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
4.2                                   This CNC has three channels of input/output device interfaces. The
                                      input/output device to be used is specified by setting the channel
PARAMETERS OF                         connected to that device in setting parameter I/O CHANNEL.
READER/PUNCHER                        The specified data, such as a baud rate and the number of stop bits, of an
INTERFACE, REMOTE                     input/output device connected to a specific channel must be set in
                                      parameters for that channel in advance.
BUFFER, DNC1,
                                      For channel 1, two combinations of parameters to specify the input/output
DNC2, AND M–NET                       device data are provided.
INTERFACE                             The following shows the interrelation between the input/output device
                                      interface parameters for the channels.
                                                       13
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS                                                                            B–63090EN/02
4.2.1
Parameters Common
to all Channels           0024         Port for communication with the PMC ladder development tool (FAPT LADDER–II/III)
                                        #7         #6        #5         #4        #3         #2         #1        #0
                          0100         ENS        IOP       ND3                  NCR        CRF        CTV
                                 NOTE
                                  In general, reading is performed more efficiently when ND3
                                  set to 1. This specification reduces the number of buffering
                                  interruptions caused by reading of a series of blocks
                                  specifying short movements. This in turn reduces the
                                  effective cycle time.
                                                  14
B–63090EN/02                                                          4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
                       ENS Action taken when a NULL code is found during read of EIA code
                           0 : An alarm is generated.
                           1 : The NULL code is ignored.
                                       #7        #6         #5         #4         #3         #2         #1         #0
                           0110                                                                                   IO4
4.2.2
Parameters of
                                       #7         #6        #5         #4         #3         #2         #1        #0
Channel 1                  0101       NFD                                         ASI                             SB2
(I/O CHANNEL=0)                       NFD                                         ASI                  HAD        SB2
                                  NOTE
                                    When input/output devices other than the FANUC PPR
                                    are used, set NFD to 1.
0102 Number specified for the input/output device (when the I/O CHANNEL is set to 0)
                                                15
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS                                                                            B–63090EN/02
4.2.3
Parameters of
                                       #7          #6        #5        #4        #3         #2         #1       #0
Channel 1                 0111        NFD                                        ASI                            SB2
(I/O CHANNEL=1)
                  [Data type] Bit
                               These parameters are used when I/O CHANNEL is set to 1. The meanings
                               of the bits are the same as for parameter 0101.
0112 Number specified for the input/output device (when I/O CHANNEL is set to 1)
                                                  16
B–63090EN/02                                                        4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
4.2.4
Parameters of
                                      #7        #6        #5        #4        #3         #2         #1       #0
Channel 2                 0121       NFD                                      ASI                            SB2
(I/O CHANNEL=2)
                  [Data type] Bit
                              These parameters are used when I/O CHANNEL is set to 2. The meanings
                              of the bits are the same as for parameter 0101.
0122 Number specified for the input/output device (when I/O CHANNEL is set to 2)
4.2.5
                                      #7        #6        #5        #4        #3         #2         #1       #0
Parameters of             0131       NFD                                      ASI                            SB2
Channel 3
(I/O CHANNEL=3)
                                 NOTE
                                  When this parameter is set, the power must be turned off
                                  before operation is continued.
0132 Number specified for the input/output device (when I/O CHANNEL is set to 3)
                                 NOTE
                                  When this parameter is set, the power must be turned off
                                  before operation is continued.
                                               17
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS                                                                          B–63090EN/02
                                 NOTE
                                  When this parameter is set, the power must be turned off
                                  before operation is continued.
                                     Set value   Baud rate (bps)                Set value Baud rate (bps)
                                         1               50                         9                2400
                                         2              100                         10               4800
                                         3              110                         11               9600
                                         4              150                         12               19200
                                         5              200                         13               38400
                                         6              300                         14               76800
                                         7              600                         14               86400
                                         8            1200
                                       #7        #6       #5         #4        #3         #2          #1     #0
                          0134                            CLK       NCD                  SYN         PRY
                                 NOTE
                                  When this parameter is set, the power must be turned off
                                  before operation is continued.
                                 NOTE
                                  When the RS–232C interface is used, set this bit to 0.
                                                 18
B–63090EN/02                                            4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
                                   #7     #6     #5      #4     #3        #2    #1      #0
                       0135       RMS                           R42      PRA   ETX     ASC
                              NOTE
                               When this parameter is set, the power must be turned off
                               before operation is continued.
                              NOTE
                                Use of ASCII/ISO is specified by ASC.
                              NOTE
                               Use a PCMCIA card attachment suited to the CNC to secure
                               the memory card in the CNC.
                                         19
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS                                                                         B–63090EN/02
4.3
                                        #7        #6        #5        #4        #3        #2         #1         #0
PARAMETERS OF               0140                                               ECD       NCE                   BCC
DNC1/DNC2
INTERFACE                          NOTE
                                     When this parameter is set, the power must be turned off
                                     before operation is continued.
                                   NOTE
                                    To use FANUC DNC2 communications library for the host
                                    computer, set this parameter to 1.
0141 System for connection between the CNC and host (DNC1 interface)
                                   NOTE
                                     When this parameter is set, the power must be turned off
                                     before operation is continued.
                                   NOTE
                                     When this parameter is set, the power must be turned off
                                     before operation is continued.
                                                 20
B–63090EN/02                                                               4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
0143 Time limit specified for the timer monitoring a response (DNC2 interface)
                                       NOTE
                                         When this parameter is set, the power must be turned off
                                         before operation is continued.
0144 Time limit specified for the timer monitoring the EOT signal (DNC2 interface)
                                       NOTE
                                         When this parameter is set, the power must be turned off
                                         before operation is continued.
0145 Time required for switching RECV and SEND (DNC2 interface)
                                       NOTE
                                         When this parameter is set, the power must be turned off
                                         before operation is continued.
0146 Number of times the system retries holding communication (DNC2 interface)
                                       NOTE
                                         When this parameter is set, the power must be turned off
                                         before operation is continued.
                                                     21
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS                                                                                B–63090EN/02
                                        Number of times the system sends the message in response to the NAK signal
                             0147
                                        (DNC2 interface)
                                    NOTE
                                      When this parameter is set, the power must be turned off
                                      before operation is continued.
                                    NOTE
                                      When this parameter is set, the power must be turned off
                                      before operation is continued.
                             0149       Number of characters in the data section of the communication packet (DNC2
                                        interface)
                                    NOTE
                                      When this parameter is set, the power must be turned off
                                      before operation is continued.
                                                   22
B–63090EN/02                                                4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
4.4
PARAMETERS OF                      #7       #6      #5       #4      #3      #2      #1       #0
REMOTE               0002                                                                    RDG
                                   #7       #6      #5       #4      #3      #2       #1     #0
                        0201               MCB                              NCR      ASC     SB2
                                           23
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS                                                                          B–63090EN/02
                               When using a modem card (when bit 6 (MCB) of parameter No. 201 is
                               set to 1)
                                    Setting   Baud rate (bps)          Setting     Baud rate (bps)
                                       1             28800                 7                    600
                                       2             38400                 8                1200
                                       3             57600                 9                2400
                                       4              –                   10                4800
                                       5              –                   11                9600
                                       6              300                 12              19200
                                   NOTE
                                    The tables above indicate the baud rates of communication
                                    between the CNC and modem. The actual communication
                                    baud rate may be lowered, depending on the modem and
                                    communication line.
                                                24
B–63090EN/02                                                       4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
                                     NOTE
                                      Once any value other than 0 is specified as a password, the
                                      password can be changed only when the same value is
                                      specified in the corresponding keyword (parameters No. 221
                                      to No. 223). If any value other than 0 is specified as a
                                      password, the password setting is not displayed on the
                                      parameter screen (blank display is provided). Take great
                                      care when setting the password.
                                                  25
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS                                                             B–63090EN/02
                                 NOTE
                                  The keyword value is reset to 0 at power–up.
                                  On the parameter screen, the keyword setting is not
                                  displayed (blank display is provided).
                                              26
B–63090EN/02                                                                   4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
4.5
PARAMETERS OF                                  #7        #6         #5          #4       #3         #2     #1           #0
DNC1 INTERFACE                   0231         NFD                                        ASI                            SB2
                                        NOTE
                                          When this parameter is set, the power must be turned off
                                          before operation is continued.
                      [Data type]
                              SB2 Number of stop bits
                                  0: 1 bit
                                  1: 2 bits
                              ASI Data input code
                                  0: IEA or ISO (automatic recognition)
                                  1: ASCII Code
                              NFD When data is out, feed holes are
                                  0: Output before and after data section
                                  1: Not output
                                        NOTE
                                          When this parameter is set, the power must be turned off
                                          before operation is continued.
                 Set value    Baud rate (bps)         Set value     Baud rate (bps)            Set value Baud rate (bps)
                     1              50                       6              300                   11            9600
                     2              100                      7              600                   12            19200
                     3              110                      8             1200                   13            38400
                     4              150                      9             2400                   14            76800
                     5              200                   10               4800                  15             86400
0241 Mode of connection between the host and CNC (DNC1 interface #2)
                                        NOTE
                                          When this parameter is set, the power must be turned off
                                          before operation is continued.
                                                        27
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS                                                                   B–63090EN/02
                                   NOTE
                                     When this parameter is set, the power must be turned off
                                     before operation is continued.
                                               28
B–63090EN/02                                               4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
4.6
PARAMETER OF                     #7       #6       #5       #4       #3       #2       #1       #0
MEMORY CARD          0300                                                                      PCM
                                         29
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS                                                                     B–63090EN/02
4.7
PARAMETERS OF                        #7     #6         #5        #4        #3       #2           #1    #0
FACTOLINK                 0801                                                                         SB2
                                     #7     #6         #5        #4        #3       #2         #1       #0
                          0810                        FMN       FTM       FYR      FCL        FAS      BGS
                                            30
B–63090EN/02                                               4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
                                       31
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS                                                                B–63090EN/02
4.8
PARAMETERS OF
                                       #7     #6       #5       #4        #3         #2     #1     #0
DATA SERVER               0900                                                             ONS    DSV
                                  NOTE
                                   When both parameters No.0911 and 0912 are set to 0, the
                                   data server assumes the following setting:
                                          No.0911 = 32 (blank)
                                          No.0912 = 92 (\)
                                              32
B–63090EN/02                                                         4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
                                                 33
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS                                                                        B–63090EN/02
4.9
PARAMETERS OF
ETHERNET                    0931               Special character code corresponding to soft key [CHAR–1]
                                               34
B–63090EN/02                                                   4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
4.10
PARAMETERS OF
POWER MATE CNC                       #7        #6      #5      #4       #3         #2    #1   #0
MANAGER                 0960                                           PMN        MD2   MD1   SLV
                                           35
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS                                                          B–63090EN/02
4.11
PARAMETERS OF
AXIS CONTROL/
INCREMENT SYSTEM                      #7      #6      #5      #4      #3      #2      #1      #0
                          1001                                                               INM
                                 NOTE
                                   When this parameter is set, the power must be turned off
                                   before operation is continued.
                                       #7     #6      #5      #4      #3      #2     #1       #0
                                      IDG                     XIK            SFD     DLZ     JAX
                          1002
                                      IDG                     XIK    AZR     SFD     DLZ     JAX
                                 NOTE
                                 1 This function can be specified for each axis by DLZx, bit 1 of
                                   parameter No.1005.
                                 2 For a system including an axis of Cs contour control or
                                   spindle positioning, avoid using this parameter. Use bit 1
                                   (DLZx) of parameter No. 1005 instead to set just a required
                                   axis.
                                 NOTE
                                  When reference position return without dogs is specified,
                                  (when bit 1 (DLZ) of parameter No.1002 is set to 1 or bit 1
                                  (DLZx) of parameter No.1005 is set to 1) the G28 command
                                  specified before a reference position is set causes P/S
                                  alarm No.090 to be issued, regardless of the setting of AZR.
                                              36
B–63090EN/02                                                          4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
                                       #7          #6        #5        #4       #3      #2        #1       #0
                                      IPR                                                        ISC
                       1004
                                      IPR                                                        ISC       ISA
                              NOTE
                                When this parameter is set, the power must be turned off
                                before operation is continued.
                              NOTE
                                IS–A cannot be used at present.
                     IPR Whether the least input increment for each axis is set to a value 10 times as
                         large as the least command increment is specified, in increment systems
                         of IS–B or IS–C at setting mm.
                         0: The least input increment is not set to a value 10 times as larg as the
                             least command increment.
                         1: The least input increment is set to a value 10 times as large as the least
                             command increment.
                           If IPR is set to 1, the least input increment is set as follows:
                                     Input increment                         Least input increment
                                            IS–B                  0.01 mm, 0.01 deg, or 0.0001 inch
                                            IS–C                  0.001 mm, 0.001 deg, or 0.00001 inch
                              NOTE
                               For IS–A, the least input increment cannot be set to a value
                               10 times as large as the least command increment.
                               The least input increment is not multiplied by 10 also when
                               the calculator–type decimal point input (bit 0 (DPI) of
                               parameter No. 3401) is used.
                                                37
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS                                                            B–63090EN/02
                                       #7      #6      #5      #4       #3      #2      #1     #0
                                      RMBx    MCCx    EDMx    EDPx                     DLZx   ZRNx
                           1005
                                      RMBx    MCCx    EDMx    EDPx     HJZx            DLZx   ZRNx
                                  NOTE
                                  1 The state in which the reference position has not been
                                    established refers to that state in which reference position
                                    return has not been performed after power–on when an
                                    absolute position detector is not being used, or that state in
                                    which the association of the machine position with the position
                                    detected with the absolute position detector has not been
                                    completed (see the description of bit 4 (APZx) of parameter
                                    No. 1815) when an absolute position detector is being used.
                                  2 To use a function that establishes the reference point and
                                    makes a movement with a command other than G28, such
                                    as an axis of Cs contour control, set this parameter for the
                                    relative axis.
                                  NOTE
                                  1 When DLZ of parameter No.1002 is 0, DLZx is enabled.
                                    When DLZ of parameter No.1002 is 1, DLZx is disabled, and
                                    the function for setting the reference position without dogs
                                    is enabled for all axes.
                                  2 Avoid setting this parameter for an axis of Cs contour control
                                    or spindle positioning.
                                  NOTE
                                   When reference position return without dogs is specified,
                                   (when bit 1 (DLZ) of parameter No.1002 is set to 1 or bit
                                   (DLZx) of parameter No.1005 is set to 1) reference position
                                   return after a reference position is set is performed using
                                   rapid traverse, regardless of the setting of HJZ.
                      EDPx External deceleration signal in the positive direction for each axis
                           0 : Valid only for rapid traverse
                           1 : Valid for rapid traverse and cutting feed
                                               38
B–63090EN/02                                                       4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
                     EDMx External deceleration signal in the negative direction for each axis
                          0 : Valid only for rapid traverse
                          1 : Valid for rapid traverse and cutting feed
                     MCCx When an axis become the removal state using the controlled axis removal
                          signal or setting:
                          0: MCC is turned off
                          1: MCC is not turned off. (Servo motor excitation is turned off, but the
                              MCC signal of the servo amplifier is not turned off.)
                                 NOTE
                                  This parameter is used to remove only one axis, for example,
                                  when a two–axis or three–axis amplifier is used. When
                                  two–a axis or three–axis amplifier is used and only one axis
                                  is removed, servo alarm No.401 (V–READY OFF) is usually
                                  issued. However, this parameter, when set to 1, prevents
                                  servo alarm No.401 from being issued.
                                  Note, however, that disconnecting a servo amplifier from the
                                  CNC will cause the servo amplifier to enter the V–READY
                                  OFF status. This is a characteristic of all multiaxis amplifiers.
                     RMBx Releasing the assignment of the control axis for each axis (signal input
                          and setting input)
                          0 : Invalid
                          1 : Valid
                                        #7       #6       #5       #4        #3       #2       #1        #0
                                                         ZMIx               DIAx              ROSx      ROTx
                          1006
                                                         ZMIx                                 ROSx      ROTx
                                 NOTE
                                  When this parameter is set, the power must be turned off
                                  before operation is continued.
                                                 39
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS                                                                    B–63090EN/02
                       DIAx Either a diameter or radius is set to be used for specifying the amount of
                            travel on each axis.
                            0 : Radius
                            1 : Diameter
                      ZMIx The direction of reference position return.
                           0 : Positive direction
                           1 : Negative direction
                                  NOTE
                                   The direction of the initial backlash, which occurs when
                                   power is switched on, is opposite to the direction of a
                                   reference position return.
                                         #7       #6       #5        #4          #3     #2     #1       #0
                           1008                                                 RAAx   RRLx   RABx     ROAx
                                  NOTE
                                   When this parameter is set, the power must be turned off
                                   before operation is continued.
                                  NOTE
                                   ROAx specifies the function only for a rotation axis (for which
                                   ROTx, #0 of parameter No.1006, is set to 1)
                                  NOTE
                                   RABx is valid only when ROAx is 1.
                                                  40
B–63090EN/02                                                        4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
                                       NOTE
                                       1 RRLx is valid only when ROAx is 1.
                                       2 Assign the amount of the shift per one rotation in parameter
                                         No.1260.
                                       NOTE
                                        When this parameter is set, the power must be turned off
                                        before operation is continued.
Examples                           Suppose that the first axis is the X axis, and the second and subsequent
                                   axes are the Y, Z, A, B, and C axes in that order, and that they are
                                   controlled as follows:
                                   X, Y, Z, and A axes: Controlled by the CNC
                                   A axis: Controlled by the CNC and PMC
                                   B and C axes: Controlled by the PMC
                                   Then set this parameter to 4 (total 4: X, Y, Z, and A)
                                                   41
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS                                                             B–63090EN/02
                                        #7      #6      #5      #4      #3      #2      #1       #0
                           1012                                                                 IDGx
                                  NOTE
                                  1 IDGx is enabled when the IDG parameter (bit 7 of parameter
                                    No.1002) is 1.
                                  2 When the function for setting the reference position, without
                                    dogs, is used, and the reference position is lost for some
                                    reason, an alarm requesting reference position return
                                    (No.300) is generated when the power is next turned on. If
                                    the operator performs reference position return, as a result
                                    of mistakenly identifying the alarm as that requesting the
                                    operator to perform a normal reference position return, an
                                    invalid reference position may be set. To prevent such an
                                    operator error, the IDGx parameter is provided to prevent the
                                    reference position from being set again without dogs.
                                     (1) If the IDG parameter (bit 7 of parameter No.1002) is set
                                         to 1, the IDGx parameter (bit 0 of parameter No.1012)
                                         is automatically set to 1 when the reference position is
                                         set using the function for setting the reference position
                                         without dogs. This prevents the reference position from
                                         being set again without dogs.
                                     (2) Once the reference position is prevented from being set
                                         for an axis again, without dogs, any attempt to set the
                                         reference position for the axis without dogs results in the
                                         output of an alarm (No.090).
                                     (3) When the reference position must be set again without
                                         dogs, set IDGx to 0 before setting the reference position.
                                               42
B–63090EN/02                                                         4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
                               NOTE
                               1 With the T series, when G code system A is used, neither U,
                                 V, nor W can be used as an axis name. Only when G code
                                 system B or C is used, U, V, and W can be used as axis
                                 names.
                               2 The same axis name cannot be assigned to more than one
                                 axis.
                               3 When the secondary auxiliary function (option) is provided,
                                 the address used by the secondary auxiliary function
                                 (address B with the T series or, with the M series, the address
                                 specified in parameter No.3460) cannot be used as an axis
                                 name.
                               4 With the T series, when address C or A is used for
                                 chamfering, corner rounding, or direct drawing dimension
                                 programming (when the CCR parameter (bit 4 of parameter
                                 No.3405) is set to 1), addresses C or A cannot be used as
                                 an axis name.
                               5 Only with the T series, address E can be used as an axis
                                 name. Address E cannot be used with the M series. When
                                 address E is used as an axis name, note the following:
                                 – When G code system A is used, address E is always
                                   assigned to an absolute command.
                                 – When an equal–lead threading command (G32) is issued
                                   in the Series 10/11 command format, address E cannot be
                                   used to specify the thread lead. Use address F to specify
                                   the thread lead.
                               NOTE
                                When this parameter is set, power must be turned off before
                                operation is continued.
                                              43
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS                                                                       B–63090EN/02
                                    NOTE
                                     When this parameter is set, power must be turned off before
                                     operation is continued.
                                                 44
B–63090EN/02                                                4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
4.12
                                   #7       #6      #5       #4       #3       #2      #1       #0
PARAMETERS OF                     WZR              AWK               FPC      ZCL      ZPI     ZPR
                       1201
COORDINATES                                        AWK               FPC      ZCL      ZPI     ZPR
                              NOTE
                              1 ZPR is valid while a workpiece coordinate system function
                                is not provided. If a workpiece coordinate system function
                                is provided, making a manual reference position return
                                always causes the workpiece coordinate system to be
                                established on the basis of the workpiece origin offset
                                (parameters No. 1220 to No. 1226), irrespective of this
                                parameter setting.
                              2 If an absolute–position coder is used in a system not using
                                a workpiece coordinate system function, set this parameter.
                                           45
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS                                                                 B–63090EN/02
                                        #7      #6       #5       #4       #3      #2       #1       #0
                                                                          RLC      G50     EWS      EWD
                           1202
                                                                  G52     RLC
X X X X
EWD=0 EWD=1
                                                        Z                          Z (Shifted workpiece
                                                                                     coordinate system)
                                         EXOFS                      –EXOFS
                                                        Z                             (Original workpiece
                                                                                   Z
                                                                                      coordinate system)
                                        EXOFS : External workpiece zero point offset value
                       EWS Shift value of the workpiece coordinate system and external workpiece
                           zero point offset value are
                           0 : Stored in the separate memory areas.
                           1 : Stored in the same memory area, that is, the shift and the offset values
                               are the same.
                        G50 When the CNC has commands G54 to G59 specifying workpiece
                            coordinate systems (optional function), if the G50 command for setting a
                            coordinate system (or the G92 command in G command system B or C) is
                            specified,
                            0 : G50 is executed and no alarm is issued.
                            1 : G50 is not executed and a P/S alarm (No. 010) is issued.
                       RLC Local coordinate system is
                           0 : Not cancelled by reset
                           1 : Cancelled by reset
                        G52 In local coordinate system setting (G52), a cutter compensation vector is:
                            0 : Not considered.
                            1 : Considered.
                                  NOTE
                                   Select a local coordinate system setting operation when
                                   cutter compensation is applied, and when two or more
                                   blocks specifying no movement exist prior to the
                                   specification of G52, or when G52 is specified after cutter
                                   compensation mode is canceled without eliminating the
                                   offset vector.
                                               46
B–63090EN/02                                                               4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
                                             #7        #6        #5         #4        #3         #2        #1       #0
                              1203                                                                                 EMC
                                     NOTE
                                     1 To use the extended external machine zero point shift
                                       function, the external machine zero point shift function or the
                                       external data input function is required.
                                     2 When the extended machine zero point shift function is
                                       enabled, the conventional external machine zero point shift
                                       function is disabled.
1221 Workpiece zero point offset value in workpiece coordinate system 1 (G54)
1222 Workpiece zero point offset value in workpiece coordinate system 2(G55)
1223 Workpiece zero point offset value in workpiece coordinate system 3(G56)
1224 Workpiece zero point offset value in workpiece coordinate system 4 (G57)
1225 Workpiece zero point offset value in workpiece coordinate system 5 (G58)
1226 Workpiece zero point offset value in workpiece coordinate system 6 (G59)
                                                      47
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS                                                                                  B–63090EN/02
                                      NOTE
                                       The workpiece origin offset can also be set using the
                                       workpiece coordinate system screen.
                                      NOTE
                                       When this parameter is set, power must be turned off before
                                       operation is continued.
                                            Coordinate value of the second reference position on each axis in the machine
                               1241
                                            coordinate system
                                            Coordinate value of the third reference position on each axis in the machine coor-
                               1242
                                            dinate system
                                            Coordinate value of the fourth reference position on each axis in the machine
                               1243
                                            coordinate system
                                                       48
B–63090EN/02                                                                 4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
                                           Coordinate value of the reference position used when automatic coordinate sys-
                              1250
                                           tem setting is performed
                                           Coordinate value of the reference position on each axis used for setting a coordi-
                              1251         nate system automatically when input is performed in inches
                                     NOTE
                                      This parameter is valid when ZPI in parameter 1201 is set to
                                      1.
                                     NOTE
                                      When this parameter is set, the power must be turned off
                                      before operation is continued.
                                                      49
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS                                                                               B–63090EN/02
                                       First address of the signal group used by the external machine zero point shift
                           1280
                                       extension
: :
: :
: :
: :
                                  NOTE
                                  1 This parameter is valid when bit 0 (EMC) of parameter No.
                                    1203 is set to 1.
                                  2 If the specified number is not present, the external machine
                                    zero point shift extension is disabled.
                                  3 A shift amount of the external machine zero point shift
                                    extension can be written from the C executer or macro
                                    executer.
                                                  50
B–63090EN/02                                               4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
4.13                               #7       #6     #5       #4      #3      #2      #1      #0
PARAMETERS OF                      BFA     LZR     RL3                     LMS             OUT
                       1300
STROKE CHECK                       BFA     LZR                             LMS             OUT
                              NOTE
                               When an absolute position detector is used and a reference
                               position is already set upon power–up, stored stroke limit
                               check 1 is started immediately after power–up, regardless of
                               the setting.
                              NOTE
                               The tool stops at a point up to F/7500 mm short of or ahead
                               of the boundary.
                               (F: Feedrate when the tool reaches the boundary (mm/min))
                                           51
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS                                                                B–63090EN/02
                                        #7      #6      #5       #4       #3       #2       #1       #0
                                                                 OF1     OTA                        DLM
                           1301
                                                        OTS      OF1     OTA                        DLM
                                  NOTE
                                   In the cases below, the automatic release function is
                                   disabled. To release an alarm, a reset operation is required.
                                   1 When a setting is made to issue an alarm before a stored
                                     stroke limit is exceeded (bit 7 (BFA) of parameter No.
                                     1300)
                                   2 When an another overtravel alarm (such as stored stroke
                                     check 2, stored stroke check 3, and interference check) is
                                     already issued
                                   3 When an overtravel alarm is already issued with the
                                     high–precision contour control function or the chopping
                                     function in the M series
                        OTS If a stored stroke limit alarm is raised by setting bit 7 (BFA) of parameter
                            No. 1300 to 1, the axial movement stops:
                            0: Before the boundary of stored stroke check.
                            1: On the boundary of stored stroke check.
                                  NOTE
                                    To enable this parameter, the manual linear/circular
                                    interpolation function is required. If this function is not
                                    provided, this parameter setting is ignored.
                                               52
B–63090EN/02                                                                  4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
                                              #7         #6         #5         #4        #3         #2         #1         #0
                                                                                                              OT3x       OT2x
                                1310
                                                                                                                         OT2x
1320 Coordinate value I of stored stroke check 1 in the positive direction on each axis
1321 Coordinate value I of stored stroke check 1 in the negative direction on each axis
                                 ÇÇÇÇÇÇÇÇÇÇÇÇ
                                 ÇÇÇÇÇÇÇÇÇÇÇÇ                             (Xp,Yp,Zp)
                                                                                         Set the machine coordinates of the
                                                                                         boundaries in the positive direction
                                 ÇÇÇÇÇÇÇÇÇÇÇÇ
                                                                                         (Xp, Yp, and Zp) using parameter No.
                                                                                         1320, and those of the boundaries in
                                 ÇÇÇÇÇÇÇÇÇÇÇÇ
                                                                                         Zm) using parameter No. 1321. The
                                        (Xm,Ym,Zm)                                       prohibited area thus becomes the
                                                                                         hatched area in the figure on the left.
                                       NOTE
                                       1 For axes with diameter specification, a diameter value must
                                         be set.
                                       2 When the parameters are set as follows, the stroke becomes
                                         infinite:
                                                   parameter 1320 < parameter 1321
                                         For movement along the axis for which infinite stroke is set,
                                         only increment commands are available. (The stored stroke
                                         limit switching signal also becomes invalid.) If an absolute
                                         command is issued for this axis, the absolute register may
                                         overflow, and normal movement will not result.
                                       3 The prohibited area specified with these parameters is
                                         invalid if bit 2 (LMS) of parameter No. 1300 is set to 1 and
                                         stored stroke limit switching signal EXLM is set to 1. In such
                                         a case, the settings of parameters No. 1326 and 1327 are
                                         used, instead.
                                                        53
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS                                                                                B–63090EN/02
1322 Coordinate value of stored stroke check 2 in the positive direction on each axis
1323 Coordinate value of stored stroke check 2 in the negative direction on each axis
                                    ÇÇÇÇÇÇÇ
                                        ÇÇÇ
                                   (1) When the prohibited area is inside the boundaries (OUT = 0)
                                                                        (Xp,Yp,Zp)
                                    ÇÇÇÇÇÇÇ
                                        ÇÇÇ
                                    ÇÇÇÇÇ
                                                                                       Set the machine coordinates of the
                                                                                       boundaries in the positive direction
                                        ÇÇÇ
                                    ÇÇÇÇÇ
                                                                                       (Xp, Yp, and Zp) using parameter
                                                                                       No. 1322, and those of the bound-
                                                                                       aries in the negative direction (Xm,
                                     (Xm,Ym,Zm)                                        Ym, and Zm) using parameter No.
                                   (2) When the prohibited area is outside             1323. The prohibited area thus
                                   ÇÇÇÇÇÇÇÇÇÇÇÇ
                                       the boundaries (OUT = 1)                        becomes the hatched area in the
                                                                                       figure on the left.
                                   ÇÇÇÇÇÇÇÇÇÇÇÇ
                                                                         (Xp,Yp,Zp)
                                   ÇÇÇÇÇÇÇÇÇÇÇÇ
                                   ÇÇÇÇÇÇÇÇÇÇÇÇ
                                   ÇÇÇÇÇÇÇÇÇÇÇÇ
                                      (Xm,Ym,Zm)
                                   NOTE
                                    For axes with diameter specification, a diameter value must
                                    be set.
                                          Coordinate value of stored stroke check 3 in the positive direction on each axis
                            1324
                                          Coordinate value of stored stroke check 3 in the positive direction on each axis
                            1325
                                                    54
B–63090EN/02                                                                4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
                                     NOTE
                                      Specify diameters for any axis for which diameter
                                      programming is specified.
1326 Coordinate value II of stored stroke check 1 in the positive direction on each axis
1327 Coordinate value II of stored stroke check 1 in the negative direction on each axis
                                     NOTE
                                     1 Specify diameter values for any axes for which diameter
                                       programming is specified.
                                     2 These parameters are invalid if bit 2 (LMS) of parameter No.
                                       1300 is set to 0, or if stored stroke limit switching signal
                                       EXLM is set to 0. In such a case, the settings of parameters
                                       No. 1320 and 1321 are used, instead.
                                                      55
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS                                                                               B–63090EN/02
4.14
PARAMETERS OF
THE CHUCK AND
TAILSTOCK                                                                Profile of a chuck
                     1330
BARRIER
(T SERIES)  [Data type] Byte
            [Valid data range] 0 or 1
                               0: Chuck which holds a workpiece on the inner surface
                               1: Chuck which holds a workpiece on the outer surface
                                                      56
B–63090EN/02                                                                    4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
    Chuck which holds a workpiece on the outer surface            Chuck which holds a workpiece on the inner surface
    (TY= 1)                                                       (TY= 0)
                                           X                                                        X
                        L            A                                          L
                                                                                          A
                            L1                                                      W1
W W
W1 CX L1 CX
                                                         Z                                                    Z
                                       CZ                                                 CZ
                                        Symbol                                      Decription
                                            Ty        Profile of a chuck (0: Chuck which holds a workpiece on the inner
                                                      surface, 1: Chuck which holdsa workpiece on the outer surface)
                                            CX        X coordinate of a chuck
                                            CZ        Z coordinate of a chuck
                                             L        Dimensions of the claw of a chuck
                                            W         Dimensions of the claw of a chuck (radius input)
                                            L1        Dimensions of the part of a claw at which a workpiece is held
                                            W1        Dimensions of the part of a claw at which a workpiece is held (ra-
                                                      dius input)
                                         NOTE
                                          Specifying the coordinates with a diameter or radius depends
                                          on whether the correspondingaxis conforms to diameter or
                                          radius specification. When the axis conforms to diameter
                                          specification, spcify the coordinates with a diameter.
                                         NOTE
                                          Always specify W and W1 with radiuses. Specify L and L1
                                          with radiuses when the Z–axis conforms to radius
                                          specification.
                                                             57
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS                                                                                 B–63090EN/02
X L
                                                                                    L1
                                  TZ
                                                                   L2
                                                     B
                      Workpiece
                                                             D3   D2                D1                 D              Z
  Zero point of
  the workpiece
  coordinate
  system
                                                             58
B–63090EN/02                                                             4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
                                        Symbol                               Description
                                          TZ       Z–axis coordinate of a tailstock
                                           L       Length of a tailstock
                                          D        Diameter of a tailstock (diameter input)
                                          L1       Length of a tailstock (1)
                                          D1       Diameter of a tailstock (1) (diameter input)
                                          L2       Length of a tailstock (2)
                                          D2       Diameter of a tailstock (2) (diameter input)
                                          D3       Diameter of the hole of a tailstock (diameter input)
                               TZ: Specifies the position (point B) of a tailstock with the Z–axis coordinate
                                   of the workpiece coordinate system. In this case, do not use the coordinate
                                   of the machine coordinate system. The profile of a tailstock is assumed to
                                   be symmetrical with respect to the Z–axis.
                                       NOTE
                                        Specifying the position of a tailstock with a radius or diameter
                                        depends on whether the Z–axis conforms to radius or
                                        diameter specification.
                                       NOTE
                                        Always specify D, D1, D2, and D3 with diameters. Specify L,
                                        L1, and L2 with radiuses if the Z–axis conforms to radius
                                        specification.
                                                     59
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS                                                          B–63090EN/02
4.15
PARAMETERS OF                         #7      #6     #5     #4       #3      #2      #1      #0
FEEDRATE                                     RDR    TDR     RF0             JZR     LRP     RPD
                          1401
                                             RDR    TDR     RF0                     LRP     RPD
                                      #7     #6      #5      #4      #3      #2      #1      #0
                                                            JRV                     JOV     NPC
                          1402
                                                                                    JOV     NPC
                                 NOTE
                                   To use a position coder, set this parameter to 0. While
                                   this parameter is set to 1, threading cannot be performed
                                   even if a position coder is provided.
                                             60
B–63090EN/02                                               4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
                              NOTE
                               Specify a feedrate in parameter No.1423.
                                   #7      #6      #5      #4       #3       #2      #1     #0
                                  RTV                                                       MIF
                       1403
                              NOTE
                               When this parameter is set, the power must be turned off
                               before operation is continued.
                              NOTE
                               M series are not equipped with this parameter. Cutting
                               feedrates are specified by F commands in units of 0.001
                               mm/min for millimeter machines or 0.00001 inches/min for
                               inch machines.
                                   #7      #6      #5      #4       #3       #2     #1       #0
                                                  EDR              FRV       F8A    DLF
                       1404
                                                  EDR              FRV       F8A    DLF     HFC
                                          61
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS                                                                         B–63090EN/02
                                  NOTE
                                   This parameter selects a feedrate for reference position
                                   return performed without dogs. This parameter also selects
                                   a feedrate when manual reference position return is
                                   performed according to bit 7 (SJZ) of parameter No.0002
                                   using rapid traverse without deceleration dogs after a
                                   reference position is set.
               <For T series>
                         F8A Valid data range for an F command in feed–per–minute mode
                              0: Range specified with bit 0 (MIF) of parameter No.1403
                               1:     Increment system            Units          IS–A, IS–B              IS–C
                                      Millimeter input        mm/min           0.001 to 240000.   0.001 to 100000.
                                      Inch input              inch/min         0.00001 to 9600.   0.00001 to 4000.
                                      Rotation axis           deg/min            1 to 240000.       1 to 100000.
              <For M series>
                        F8A Valid data range for an F command with a decimal point in feed–per
                             minute mode
                               0:     Increment system            Units          IS–A, IS–B              IS–C
                                      Millimeter input        mm/min                   0.001 to 99999.999.
                                      Inch input              inch/min                0.00001 to 999.99999.
                                      Rotation axis (mm)      deg/min            1 to 240000.       1 to 100000.
                                      Rotation axis (inch)    deg/min             1 to 9600.         1 to 4000.
                        FRV For inch input, the valid range of the feedrate specified for feed per
                            revolution is:
                            0 : Standard range. (F0.000001 to 9.999999 inches per revolution)
                            1 : Extended to F50.0 inches per revolution. (F0.000001 to 50.000000
                                inches per revolution)
                        EDR The external deceleration speed in liner interpolation type positioning is
                            set in:
                            0: Parameter No. 1426.
                            1: Parameter No. 1427, for the first axis.
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0
                           1405
                                                                                                   FD3          F1U
                                                  62
B–63090EN/02                                                                4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
                             FD3 The number of significant digits of the fractional part in the feedrate
                                 command (F command) for feed per revolution is:
                                 0 : Up to two decimal positions (three decimal positions for inch input).
                                 1 : Up to three decimal positions (four decimal positions for inch input).
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0
                                1408
                                                                                                                  RFD
Set the dry run rate when the manual feedrate is overridden by 100%.
                                1411
                                                           Cutting feedrate in the automatic mode at power–on
                                                      63
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS                                                                              B–63090EN/02
                               Set the rapid traverse rate when the rapid traverse override is 100% for
                               each axis.
                               Set the F0 rate of the rapid traverse override for each axis.
                                    Rapid traverse override signal
                                                                                    Override value
                                      ROV2                ROV1
                                        0                   0                            100%
                                        0                   1                             50%
                                        1                   0                             25%
                                        1                   1                              F0
                                                                                       F0: Parameter 1421
                           1422                            Maximum cutting feedrate for all axes
                                                 64
B–63090EN/02                                                                 4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
                                         NOTE
                                         1 A maximum cutting feedrate can be specified for each axis
                                           only during linear interpolation and circular interpolation by
                                           using parameter No. 1430.
                                         2 Even when parameter No. 1430 is used, clamping to a
                                           maximum cutting feedrate based on parameter No. 1422 is
                                           enabled during polar coordinate interpolation, cylindrical
                                           interpolation, and involute interpolation (M series).
1423 Feedrate in manual continuous feed (jog feed) for each axis
                                     (2) When JRV, bit 4 of parameter No.1402, is set to 1 (feed per revolution)
                                         in T series, specify a jog feedarate (feed per revolution) under an
                                         override of 100%.
               [Unit of data, valid range]
                                           Increment system          Unit of data               Valid data range
                                         Millimeter machine        0.01 mm/rev
                                         Inch machine              0.001 mm/rev                     0 to 32767
                                         Rotation axis             0.01 deg/rev
                                         NOTE
                                          If 0 is set, the rate set in parameter 1420 is assumed.
                                                        65
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS                                                                                    B–63090EN/02
                                  Set feedrate (FL rate) after deceleration when the reference position return
                                  is performed for each axis.
Set the external deceleration rate of rapid traverse for each axis.
                                                  66
B–63090EN/02                                                                4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
                                       NOTE
                                       1 This parameter is valid only during linear interpolation and
                                          circular interpolation. Even when this parameter is set,
                                          clamping to a maximum cutting feedrate based on
                                          parameter No. 1422 is enabled during polar coordinate
                                          interpolation, cylindrical interpolation, and involute
                                          interpolation (M series).
                                       2 When this parameter is set to 0 for all axes, clamping to a
                                          maximum cutting feedrate based on parameter No. 1422 is
                                          enabled.
                                       This means that if a value other than 0 is set for any of the axes
                                       with this parameter, clamping to a maximum cutting feedrate
                                       is performed for all axes during linear interpolation or circular
                                       interpolation according to this parameter.
                                1431
                                                 Maximum cutting feedrate for all axes in the look–ahead control mode
                                   Specify the maximum cutting feedrate for all axes in the look–ahead
                                   control mode.
                                   A feedrate in the tangential direction is clamped in cutting feed so that it
                                   does not exceed the feedrate specified in this parameter.
                                       NOTE
                                       1 To specify the maximum cutting feedrate for each axis, use
                                         parameter No.1432 instead.
                                       2 In a mode other than the look–ahead mode, the maximum
                                         cutting feedrate specified in parameter No.1422 or No.1430
                                         is applied and the feedrate is clamped at the maximum
                                         feedrate.
                                1432
                                           Maximum cutting feedrate for each axis in the AI look–ahead control mode or look–
                                                                         ahead control mode
                                                       67
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS                                                                           B–63090EN/02
                               Specify the maximum cutting feedrate for each axis in the AI look–ahead
                               control mode or look–ahead control mode.
                               A feedrate for each axis is clamped during cutting feed so that it does not
                               exceed the maximum cutting feedrate specified for each axis.
                                   NOTE
                                   1 This parameter is effective only in linear and circular
                                     interpolation. In cylindrical interpolation, the maximum
                                     feedrate for all axes specified in parameter No.1431 is
                                     effective.
                                   2 If a setting for each axis is 0, the maximum feedrate specified
                                     in parameter No.1431 is applied to all axes and the feedrate
                                     is clamped at the maximum feedrate.
                                   3 In a mode other than the AI look–ahead control mode or
                                     look–ahead mode, the maximum cutting feedrate specified
                                     in parameter No.1422 or No.1430 is applied and the
                                     feedrate is clamped at the maximum feedrate.
                            1450
                                       Change of feedrate for one graduation on the manual pulse generator during F1
                                       digit feed
                                                 68
B–63090EN/02                                                         4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
                                1451
                                                            Feedrate for F1 digit command F1
                                1452
                                                            Feedrate for F1 digit command F2
                                1453
                                                            Feedrate for F1 digit command F3
                                1454
                                                            Feedrate for F1 digit command F4
                                1455
                                                            Feedrate for F1 digit command F5
                                1456
                                                            Feedrate for F1 digit command F6
                                1457
                                                            Feedrate for F1 digit command F7
                                1458
                                                            Feedrate for F1 digit command F8
                                1459
                                                            Feedrate for F1 digit command F9
                                   These parameters set the feedrates for 1–digit feed commands F1 to F9.
                                   When an 1–digit feed command is specified, and the feedrate is changed
                                   by turning the manual pulse generator, the parameter–set value also
                                   changes accordingly.
                                                      69
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS                                                                                          B–63090EN/02
                             1460
                                                   Upper limit of feedrate for the one–digit F code command (F1 to F4)
                             1461
                                                   Upper limit of feedrate for the one–digit F code command (F5 to F9)
                             1465
                                                            Virtual radius for feedrate control about rotation axis
                                    NOTE
                                    1 Note that the increment system remains unchanged
                                      regardless of whether metric input or inch input is used.
                                    2 This function is enabled when bit 0 (ROTx) of parameter No.
                                      1006 and bit 0 (RFDx) of parameter No. 1408 are set to 1.
                                    3 Be careful when setting bit 0 (RFDx) of parameter No. 1408
                                      and parameter No. 1465 (virtual radius). In particular, when
                                      this function is used with a small virtual radius value, axis
                                      movement speeds up.
                                    4 If a large value is set for the amount of travel and parameter
                                      No. 1465 (virtual radius), an alarm (P/S 5307: Internal data
                                      exceeded an allowable range.) is issued.
                                    5 This function cannot be used in the following modes:
                                         Rapid traverse, feed per revolution (G94), threading, AI
                                         look–ahead control, high–speed remote buffer A,
                                         high–speed remote buffer B
                                                       70
B–63090EN/02                                                        4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
4.16
PARAMETERS OF
                                          #7      #6        #5       #4      #3         #2     #1       #0
ACCELERATION/                                               NCI     RTO
DECELERATION         1601
                                                            NCI     RTO                 OVB
CONTROL     [Data type] Bit
                           OVB Block overlap in cutting feed
                               0: Blocks are not overlapped in cutting feed.
                               1: Blocks are overlapped in cutting feed.
                                  Block overlap outputs the pulses remaining at the end of pulse
                                  distribution in a block together with distribution pulses in the next block.
                                  This eliminates changes in feedrates between blocks.
                                  Block overlap is enabled when blocks containing G01, G02, or G03 are
                                  consecutively specified in G64 mode. If minute blocks, however, are
                                  specified consecutively, overlap may not be performed.
                                  The following pulses in block F2 are added to the pulses remaining at the
                                  end of pulse distribution in block F1.
                                                  (Number of pulses required at the end of block F1)
         (Number of pulses to be added) = F2
                                                                              F1
                                  When F1 = F2
                                     F             F1
                                                                    ÉÉ
                                                                     É
                                                                     ÉÉÉÉ
                                                                        É
                                                                        ÉÉÉ
                                                                          ÉÉÉÉ
                                                                             É
                                                                             ÉÉÉÉ  F2
                                                                    ÉÉ
                                                                     É
                                                                     ÉÉÉÉ
                                                                        É
                                                                        ÉÉÉ
                                                                          ÉÉÉÉ
                                                                             É
                                                                             ÉÉÉÉ
                                                                                É
                                                                    ÉÉ
                                                                     É
                                                                     ÉÉ
                                                                    ÉÉ ÉÉ
                                                                        É
                                                                        ÉÉ
                                                                     ÉÉÉÉÉ
                                                                     ÉÉ   É
                                                                          ÉÉ
                                                                        ÉÉÉ ÉÉ
                                                                             É
                                                                             ÉÉ
                                                                          ÉÉÉÉÉÉÉ
                                                                             ÉÉÉÉ
                                                                                É                            t
                                                                  ÉÉ
                                                                   ÉÉ
                                                                    É
                                                                    ÉÉÉÉ
                                                                       É
                                                                       ÉÉÉ
                                                                         ÉÉÉÉ
                                                                            É
                                                                            ÉÉÉÉ
                                     F              F1                             F2
                                                                  ÉÉ
                                                                   ÉÉ
                                                                    ÉÉÉÉÉ
                                                                    ÉÉ ÉÉÉ
                                                                         ÉÉÉÉÉ
                                                                            ÉÉÉ
                                                                   ÉÉ
                                                                    ÉÉÉÉÉ
                                                                    ÉÉ ÉÉÉ
                                                                         ÉÉÉÉÉ
                                                                            ÉÉÉÉ
                                                                   ÉÉ
                                                                    ÉÉÉÉÉ
                                                                    ÉÉ ÉÉÉ
                                                                         ÉÉÉÉÉ
                                                                            ÉÉÉÉ                                 t
                                    NOTE
                                     See the description of parameter No.1722.
                                                  71
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS                                                                                B–63090EN/02
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0
                                   1602
                                                           LS2               CSD       BS2       COV                FWB
F2 Type B F2
     F1                                              Time F1                                                     Time
              N1               N2                                        N1               N2
     To change the feedrate from F3 to F2, it is necessary to start reducing the feedrate at point 1.
                               COV The outer arc cutting feedrate change function of the automatic corner
                                   override function is:
                                   0 : Not used.
                                   1 : Used.
                                BS2 Acceleration/deceleration after interpolation for cutting feed in
                                    look–ahead control mode is:
                                    0 : Exponential acceleration/deceleration or linear acceleration/
                                        deceleration (one of which is selected by the LS2 parameter (bit 6 of
                                        parameter No.1602)).
                                    1 : Bell–shaped acceleration/deceleration.
                                          BS2        LS2                      Acceleration/deceleration
                                           0          0    Exponential acceleration/deceleration after interpolation
                                           0          1    Linear acceleration/deceleration after interpolation. (The
                                                           option for linear acceleration/deceleration after interpolation
                                                           for cutting feed is required.)
                                           1          0    Bell–shaped acceleration/deceleration after interpolation.
                                                           (The option for bell–shaped acceleration/deceleration after
                                                           interpolation for cutting feed is required.)
                                                           72
B–63090EN/02                                                4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
                                    #7      #6      #5       #4      #3       #2      #1       #0
                                                            PRT
                        1603
                                           RBL              PRT
                               NOTE
                                 This parameter is invalid if the function of bell–shaped
                                 acceleration/deceleration after rapid–traverse
                                 interpolation is provided. The acceleration/deceleration
                                 time constant and override for rapid traverse are used.
                               NOTE
                                 Bit 4 (PRT) of parameter No. 1603 is invalid.
                                    #7      #6      #5      #4       #3       #2      #1       #0
                        1610                               JGLx                      CTBx     CTLx
                                           73
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS                                                                            B–63090EN/02
                                  NOTE
                                   If the optional function of linear acceleration/deceleration
                                   after interpolation in cutting feed is not provided, exponential
                                   acceleration/deceleration is used irrespective of this setting.
                                   To use bell–shaped acceleration/deceleration after
                                   interpolation, set this parameter to 0 and select the
                                   acceleration/deceleration using CTBx, bit 1 of parameter
                                   No.1610.
                                    Parameter
                                                                     Acceleration/deceleration
                                   CTBx CTLx
                                     0     0          Exponential acceleration/deceleration
                                     0     1          Linear acceleration/deceleration after interpolation
                                     1     0          Bell–shaped acceleration/deceleration after interpolation
                                  NOTE
                                   This parameter is effective only when the function of
                                   bell–shaped acceleration/deceleration after interpolation in
                                   cutting feed is provided. If the function is not provided, the
                                   setting in CTLx, bit 0 of parameter No.1610, determines the
                                   type of acceleration/deceleration irrespective of the setting
                                   in this parameter.
                                                 74
B–63090EN/02                                                                      4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
                                            NOTE
                                             When parameter No.1621 (time constant T2 used for
                                             bell–shaped acceleration/deceleration in rapid traverse) is
                                             set to 0, linear acceleration/deceleration is applied in rapid
                                             traverse even if the function is provided. In this case, this
                                             parameter stands for a time constant used in linear
                                             acceleration/deceleration in rapid traverse.
                                                                  TIme
                           T2/2        T1             T2/2
                             T2
                                         Set the value when the rapid traverse rate is 100%. If it is under 100%, the
                                         total time is reduced. (Constant acceleration method)
                                         The value of T1 is determined from the torque of motor. Usually set the
                                         value of T2 to 24 ms ir 32 ms.
                                                             75
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS                                                                                       B–63090EN/02
                                             NOTE
                                             1 This parameter is effective when the function of bell–shaped
                                               acceleration/deceleration in rapid traverse is provided. Set
                                               parameter No.1620 to time constant T1 used for
                                               bell–shaped acceleration/deceleration in rapid traverse, and
                                               set this parameter to time constant T2.
                                               For details of time constants T1 and T2, see the description
                                               of parameter No.1620.
                                             2 When this parameter is set to 0, linear acceleration/
                                               deceleration is applied in rapid traverse. The setting in
                                               parameter No.1620 is used as a time constant in linear
                                               acceleration/deceleration.
           Speed
                                                       T : Total time. it is constant irrespective of feed rate.
                                                            (Time constant is constant).
                                                      Time
                             T
                                                            76
B–63090EN/02                                                                  4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
                                       NOTE
                                        Except for special applications, this parameter must be set
                                        to 0 for all axes. If a value other than 0 is specified, proper
                                        straight lines and arcs cannot be obtained.
                                                        77
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS                                                                                  B–63090EN/02
[Unit of data] ms
                            1710          Minimum deceleration ratio (MDR) of the inner circular cutting rate in automatic
                                          corner override
[Unit of data] %
                                 This parameter sets the minimum deceleration ratio (MDR) when the
                                 inner circular cutting speed is changed by automatic corner override.
                                 In circular cutting with an inward offset, the actual feedrate for a specified
                                 feedrate (F) is expressed as follows:
                                                Rc               Rc: Radius of the path of the cutter’s center.
                                    F
                                               Rp                Rp: Programmed radius
                                                     78
B–63090EN/02                                                               4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
                                                                    Rc
                                                                         Path of the               Programmed path
                                                           Rp            cutter’s center
                                   If Rc is too small in comparison with Rp, such that Rc/Rp 8 0, the cutter
                                   will stop. To prevent this, a minimum deceleration ratio (MDR) is set.
                                1711
                                                Angle (θp) used to recognize an inner corner in inner corner override
                                1712
                                                                Amount of override for an inner corner
                                1713
                                                     Distance Le from the starting point in inner corner override
                                1714
                                                     Distance Ls up to the ending point in inner corner override
                                                     79
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS                                                                                   B–63090EN/02
                                                                                       Ls
                                                               Le
                                                                          θ                 b                 Programmed
                                                      a                                                       path
                                                                                                         Cutter center
                                                                                                         path
                                                      An override is applied from point a to b.
1722 Rapid traverse feedrate reduction ratio for overlapping rapid traverse blocks
N1 G00 X– – ; N2 G00 X– – ;
                                                       80
B–63090EN/02                                                              4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
                                     NOTE
                                      The parameter No.1722 is effective when parameter
                                      No.1601 #4 (RT0) is set to 1.
                              1730
                                                                Maximum feedrate for arc radius R
                                    Set a maximum feedrate for the arc radius set in parameter No.1731. Set
                                    this parameter when the arc radius–based feedrate clamping function is
                                    enabled.
                              1731
                                                       Arc radius value corresponding to a maximum feedrate
                              1732
                                                    Minimum value (RV min) for arc radius–based feedrate clamp
                                                     81
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS                                                                                 B–63090EN/02
                            1762         Exponential acceleration/deceleration time constant for cutting feed in the look–
                                         ahead control mode
                                    NOTE
                                    1 For linear acceleration/deceleration, the function of linear
                                      acceleration/deceleration after cutting feed interpolation is
                                      required.
                                    2 For bell–shaped acceleration/deceleration, the function of
                                      bell–shaped acceleration/deceleration after cutting feed
                                      interpolation is required.
                            1770         Parameter 1 (for look–ahead control) for setting an acceleration for linear ac-
                                         celeration/deceleration before interpolation (maximum machining speed during
                                         linear acceleration/deceleration before interpolation)
                                                    82
B–63090EN/02                                                          4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
                                            Parameter 1
                                            (No.1770)
                                                                                                       Time
                                                                   Parameter 2 (No.1771)
                                 NOTE
                                  When 0 is set in parameter No.1770 or parameter No.1771,
                                  linear acceleration/deceleration before interpolation is
                                  disabled.
                          1771       Parameter 2 (for look–ahead control) for setting an acceleration for linear ac-
                                     celeration/deceleration before interpolation (time used to reach the maximum
                                     machining speed during linear acceleration/deceleration before interpolation)
                                 NOTE
                                 1 When 0 is set in parameter No.1770 or parameter No.1771,
                                   linear acceleration/deceleration before interpolation is
                                   disabled.
                                 2 In parameter Nos. 1770 and 1771, set values that satisfy the
                                   following:
                                   Parameter No.1770/Parameter No.1771 y 5
                                                83
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS                                                                                      B–63090EN/02
                                    1777
                                               Minimum speed for the automatic corner deceleration function (look–ahead control)
                                    1779        Critical angle subtended by two blocks for automatic corner deceleration (for
                                                look–ahead control)
Block A (G01)
                                            Block B (G01)
                                θ                                                                 θ
                                                                 Block A (G02)
                                                                                               Block B (G01)
         Angle subtended by two straight lines                    Angle subtended by an arc and its tangent
                                    1780        Allowable speed difference for the speed difference–based corner deceleration
                                                function (for look–ahead control)
                                       Set the speed difference for the speed difference–based automatic corner
                                       deceleration function when linear acceleration/deceleration before
                                       interpolation is used.
                                                            84
B–63090EN/02                                                                 4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
                                 1783        Allowable speed difference for the speed difference based corner deceleration
                                             function (for look–ahead control)
                                    A separate allowable feedrate difference can be set for each axis. The
                                    allowable feedrate difference is set for each axis with this parameter.
                                    Among the axes that exeed the specified allowable feedrate difference, the
                                    axis with the greatest ratio of the actual feedrate difference to the
                                    allowable feedrate difference is used as the reference to calculate the
                                    reduced feedrate at the corner.
                                        NOTE
                                        1 When 0 is set in this parameter, the control described above
                                          is not exercised.
                                        2 Use type–B linear acceleration/deceleration before
                                          interpolation (by setting bit 0 (FWB) of parameter No.1602
                                          to 1).
                                        3 The control described above is applicable only to stored
                                          stroke check 1.
                                                       85
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS                                                                          B–63090EN/02
                           1785      Parameter for determining an allowable acceleration when the feedrate is set by
                                     acceleration
                                               86
B–63090EN/02                                               4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
4.17
                                   #7         #6     #5     #4       #3      #2         #1          #0
PARAMETERS OF          1800                         TRC    RBK      FFR     OZR        CVR
SERVO
               [Data type] Bit
                    CVR When velocity control ready signal VRDY is set ON before position
                        control ready signal PRDY comes ON
                        0: A servo alarm is generated.
                        1: A servo alarm is not generated.
                    OZR When manual reference position return is attempted in the halt state
                        during automatic operation (feed hold stop state) under any of the
                        conditions listed below:
                        0: Manual reference position return is not performed, with P/S alarm
                            No.091.
                        1: Manual reference position return is performed without an alarm
                            occurring.
                           < Conditions >
                                   #7         #6    #5     #4       #3         #2       #1         #0
                                                    CIN    CCI      API                PM2        PM1
                       1801
                                                    CIN    CCI      API
API To use an absolute position detector for any axis, set API to 1.
                                              87
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS                                                              B–63090EN/02
                                       #7      #6      #5      #4       #3       #2      #1      #0
                                                      DPS      B15              DC2              CTS
                           1802
                                      FWC                      B15              DC2
                                  NOTE
                                   After this parameter is set, the power needs to be turned off.
                                       #7      #6      #5       #4      #3       #2       #1     #0
                           1803                                TQF                       TQA     TQI
                                              88
B–63090EN/02                                                4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
                                    #7       #6     #5       #4     #3       #2       #1      #0
                        1804                SAK    ANA      IVO                      BLC
                               NOTE
                                When a reset is issued while the VRDY OFF alarm ignore
                                signal is set to 1 and the motor activating current is low, the
                                reset state can also be released, provided this parameter is
                                set to 1.
                                    #7      #6      #5      #4      #3       #2       #1      #0
                        1805                                                         TQU
                               NOTE
                               1 This parameter is valid if follow–up is not performed (bit 4
                                 (TQF) of parameter No. 1803 is set to 0).
                               2 When torque control is switched to position control, a
                                 reference position return must be made.
                                    #7      #6      #5      #4      #3       #2      #1       #0
                        1815                       APCx    APZx             DCLx    OPTx
                               NOTE
                                When this parameter has been set, the power must be
                                turned off before operation is continued.
                                            89
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS                                                               B–63090EN/02
                                  NOTE
                                   When using the linear scale with reference marks, also set
                                   the OPTx parameter (bit 1 of parameter No.1815) to 1.
                      APZx Machine position and position on absolute position detector when the
                           absolute position detector is used
                           0 : Not corresponding
                           1 : Corresponding
                                  NOTE
                                   When an absolute position detector is used, after primary
                                   adjustment is performed or after the absolute position
                                   detector is replaced, this parameter must be set to 0, power
                                   must be turned off and on, then manual reference position
                                   return must be performed. This completes the positional
                                   correspondence between the machine position and the
                                   position on the absolute position detector, and sets this
                                   parameter to 1 automatically.
                                  NOTE
                                   When this parameter has been set, the power must be
                                   turned off before operation is continued.
                                              90
B–63090EN/02                                                  4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
                                     #7      #6       #5      #4       #3       #2       #1      #0
                        1818                                                   DG0x     RF2x    RFSx
                    RFSx On an axis using a linear scale with absolute addressing reference marks,
                         if an automatic reference position return (G28) is made before the
                         reference position is established, the reference position is established first,
                            then:
                            0: A movement to the reference position is made.
                            1: A movement to the reference position is not made, but the operation is
                               completed.
                    RF2x On an axis using a linear scale with absolute addressing reference marks,
                         if an automatic reference position return (G28) is made after the reference
                         position is established,
                         0: A movement to the reference position is made.
                         1: A movement to the reference position is not made, but the operation is
                              completed.
                   DG0x On an axis using a linear scale with absolute addressing reference marks, a
                        reference position return by jog feed or a rapid traverse command is:
                        0: Disabled.
                        1: Enabled.
                                     #7      #6       #5      #4       #3       #2      #1       #0
                                                                               DATx    CRFx     FUPx
                        1819
                                    NAHx                                       DATx    CRFx     FUPx
                   FUPx To perform follow–up when the servo is off is set for each axis.
                        0: The follow–up signal, *FLWU, determines whether follow–up is
                           performed or not.
                           When *FLWU is 0, follow–up is performed.
                           When *FLWU is 1, follow–up is not performed.
                        1: Follow–up is not performed.
                               NOTE
                                When the index table indexing function (M series) is used,
                                be sure to set FUPx of the 4th axis to 1.
                   DATx On a linear scale with absolute addressing reference marks, the automatic
                        setting of parameters No. 1883 and No. 1884 is:
                        0: Not performed.
                        1: Performed.
                                            91
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS                                                                                    B–63090EN/02
                                  NOTE
                                    This parameter is automatically set to 0 when the manual
                                    reference position return is completed.
                                  NOTE
                                   Set1 for a PMC–based control axis.
                                  NOTE
                                   When this parameter has been set, the power must be
                                   turned off before operation is continued.
                                                                                                                    Least
                                                                              Least input increment               command
                                                                                                                  increment
                                  IS–C   Millimeter        Millimeter   0.0001 mm (diameter specification)       0.00005 mm
                                         machine             input
                                                                        0.0001 mm (radius specification)         0.0001 mm
                                                           Inch input   0.00001 inch (diameter specification)    0.00005 mm
                                                                        0.00001 inch (radius specification)      0.0001 mm
                                          Inch             Millimeter   0.0001 mm (diameter specification)       0.000005 inch
                                         machine             input
                                                                        0.0001 mm (radius specification)         0.00001 inch
                                                           Inch input   0.00001 inch (diameter specification)    0.000005 inch
                                                                        0.00001 inch (radius specification)      0.00001 inch
                                              Rotation axis             0.0001 deg                               0.0001 deg
                                                      92
 B–63090EN/02                                                                   4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
                                       (2) M series
                                            Increment          Least input increment and least command increment
                                              system                 IS–A         IS–B             IS–C                Units
                                        Millimeter machine    0.01             0.001           0.0001           mm
                                        Inch machine          0.001            0.0001          0.00001          inch
                                        Rotation axis         0.01             0.001           0.0001           deg
                                               +                                       DA
                        X CMR                                Error counter             Converter         To velocity control
    least command                              –
    increment
                                                                             Feedback pulse
                                Reference
                                counter                        X DMR                               Position detector
                                                Detection
                                                unit
Fig.4.17 (a) CMR, DMR, and the Capacity of the Reference Counter
                                       Set the magnification ratios of CMR and DMR so that the weight of
                                       positive inputs to the error counter equals that of negative inputs.
                                        NOTE
                                         When command multiplier is 1 to 48, the set value must be
                                         determined so that an integer can be set for command
                                         multiplier.
                                                         93
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS                                                                           B–63090EN/02
                                    NOTE
                                     When this parameter has been set, the power must be
                                     turned off before operation is continued.
                                When using the linear scale with reference marks, set the space between
                                the mark–1 indications.
                                                94
B–63090EN/02                                                              4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
1829 Positioning deviation limit for each axis in the stopped state
                                      NOTE
                                       When this parameter is set to 0, no positional deviation limit
                                       check is made at servo–off time.
                                                   95
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS                                                                               B–63090EN/02
                                     NOTE
                                      When bit 0 (PLC01) of parameter No.2000 is set to 1, a value
                                      ten times greater than the value set in this parameter is used
                                      to make the check.
                                      Example
                                      When the value 10 is set in this parameter, and bit 0 (PLC01)
                                      of parameter No.2000 is set to 1, reference
                                         Limit of position deviation during movement in the safety signal mode C for each
                              1838
                                         axis
                                     NOTE
                                      When this parameter has been set, the power must be
                                      turned off before operation is continued.
                                                    96
B–63090EN/02                                                                      4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
1852 Backlash compensating value used for rapid traverse for each axis
    ÇÇÇÇÇÇÇÇÇÇÇÇÇ ÇÇÇÇÇÇÇÇÇÇÇÇÇ
                Stopped during cutting feed                               Stopped during rapid traverse
    ÇÇÇÇÇÇÇÇÇÇÇÇÇ ÇÇÇÇÇÇÇÇÇÇÇÇÇ
     ÊÊÊÊÊÊÊÊÊÊÊÊÊ
    ÇÇÇÇÇÇÇÇÇÇÇÇÇ
    ÇÇÇÇÇÇÇÇÇÇÇÇÇ
     ÊÊÊÊÊÊÊÊÊÊÊÊÊ
                   ÊÊÊÊÊÊÊÊÊÊÊÊÊ
                  ÇÇÇÇÇÇÇÇÇÇÇÇÇ
                  ÇÇÇÇÇÇÇÇÇÇÇÇÇ
                   ÊÊÊÊÊÊÊÊÊÊÊÊÊ
                           A
                                                                           a
                                                                                      B
                                                                                                              a
     ÊÊÊÊÊÊÊÊÊÊÊÊÊ
    ÇÇÇÇÇÇÇÇÇÇÇÇÇ
    ÇÇÇÇÇÇÇÇÇÇÇÇÇ
     ÊÊÊÊÊÊÊÊÊÊÊÊÊ
                   ÊÊÊÊÊÊÊÊÊÊÊÊÊ
                  ÇÇÇÇÇÇÇÇÇÇÇÇÇ
                  ÇÇÇÇÇÇÇÇÇÇÇÇÇ
                   ÊÊÊÊÊÊÊÊÊÊÊÊÊ
     ÊÊÊÊÊÊÊÊÊÊÊÊÊ ÊÊÊÊÊÊÊÊÊÊÊÊÊ
     Assign the measured backlash at cutting feed (A) in parameter No.1851 and that at rapid traverse (B) in param-
     eter No.1852.
 NOTE
 1 Jog feed is regarded as cutting feed.
 2 The backlash compensation depending on a rapid traverse and a cutting feed is not performed
   until the first reference position return is completed after the power is turned on. The normal
   backlash compensation is performed according to the value specified in parameter No.1851
   irrespective of a rapid traverse and a cutting feed.
 3 The backlash compensation depending on a rapid traverse and a cutting feed is performed only
   when RBK, #4 of parameter No.1800, is set to 1. When RBK is set to 0, the normal backlash
   is performed.
                                                            97
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS                                                                           B–63090EN/02
                                  NOTE
                                   When this parameter has been set, the power must be
                                   turned off before operation is continued.
                                  NOTE
                                   When this parameter has been set, the power must be
                                   turned off before operation is continued.
                                  SUPPLEMENTAL REMARK
                                    To use an absolute–position detector using Inductosyn, set
                                    the following digital servo parameters as well:
                                                98
B–63090EN/02                                                              4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
                                      NOTE
                                       This parameter is enabled when the ANA parameter (bit 5 of
                                       parameter No.1804) is 1.
1882 Space between the mark–2 indications on the linear scale with reference marks
                                      NOTE
                                       After this parameter has been set, the power must be turned
                                       off then back on for the setting to become effective.
                                                     99
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS                                                                                  B–63090EN/02
                                         Distance from the zero point of the linear scale with reference marks to the ref-
                           1883
                                         erence position
                                  NOTE
                                   After this parameter has been set, the power must be turned
                                   off then back on for the setting to become effective.
Parameter No.1821
Parameter No.1882
Parameter No.1883
                                        Distance 2 from the zero point of the linear scale with absolute addressing refer-
                           1884
                                        ence marks to the reference position
                                  NOTE
                                   After this parameter is set, the power must be turned off then
                                   back on for the setting to become effective.
                                                    100
B–63090EN/02                                                           4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
1885 Maximum allowable value for total travel during torque control
                                     NOTE
                                      This parameter is enabled when the TQF parameter (bit 4 of
                                      parameter No.1803) is 0 (follow–up is not performed during
                                      torque control).
                                     NOTE
                                      This parameter is enabled when the TQF parameter (bit 4 of
                                      parameter No.1803) is 0 (follow–up is not performed during
                                      torque control).
                                          #7        #6       #5         #4        #3         #2         #1        #0
                              1902                 DCE                            STP                  ASE       FMD
                                     NOTE
                                      After this parameter has been set, the power must be turned
                                      off then back on for the setting to become effective.
                                                   101
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS                                                          B–63090EN/02
                      ASE When automatic setting mode is selected for FSSB setting (when the FMD
                          parameter (bit 0 of parameter No.1902) is set to 0), automatic setting is:
                          0 : Not completed.
                          1 : Completed.
                              (This bit is automatically set to 1 upon the completion of automatic
                              setting.)
                       STP With the dual check safety function, in the self test mode at power–up, a
                           self test of safety output signal is:
                           0 : Performed. (At power–up, the “CARRY OUT A SAFETY TEST”
                               warning appears, and the self test execution request signal RQT is
                               output.)
                           1 : Not performed.
                               CAUTION
                               1 The STP bit is temporarily used if an MCC shut–off test of
                                 safety output signal in the MCC shut–off test mode is not
                                 wanted at power–up when the machine is adjusted, for
                                 instance.
                               2 Even if STP is set to 1, an MCC shut–off test of safety output
                                 signal in the MCC shut–off test mode is required when the
                                 power is turned on after 24 hours have elapsed since the
                                 completion of the previous MCC shut–off test.
                               WARNING
                                 If STP is temporarily set to 1 for machine adjustment or the
                                 like, reset STP to 0.
                               CAUTION
                                 For a machine using the dual check safety function, usually
                                 set DCE to 1. If DCE is 0, the MCC on enable signal MCF
                                 will not be brought to 1 (MCC on enabled), and the machine
                                 will not be activated.
                               WARNING
                                 Always set the bits other than FMD, ASE, STP, and DCE of
                                 parameter No. 1902 to 0. If 1 is set in any of those bits, the
                                 safety function may not normally work.
                                           102
B–63090EN/02                                                 4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
                                    #7      #6      #5       #4       #3      #2       #1       #0
                        1904                                                                   DSP
                               NOTE
                                After this parameter has been set, the power must be turned
                                off then back on for the setting to become effective.
                               NOTE
                                Parameter No.1904 is set on the FSSB setting screen. So,
                                parameter No.1904 should not have to be specified directly.
                                This parameter need not be set in FSSB manual setting 2
                                mode.
                                    #7      #6       #5       #4      #3      #2       #1      #0
                        1905       PM2     PM1      IO2      IO1                               FSL
                               NOTE
                                After this parameter has been set, the power must be turned
                                off then back on for the setting to become effective.
                                           103
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS                                                                    B–63090EN/02
CNC
                                      1              X         1           F         2–axis        X (Fast)
                                      2              Y         2           F        amplifier
                                      3              Z         3           S                       A (Slow)
                                      4              A         4           S         1–axis        Y (Fast)
                                                                                    amplifier
                                                                                     1–axis        Z (Slow)
                                                                                    amplifier
                               NOTE
                                When automatic setting mode is selected for FSSB setting
                                (when the FMD parameter (bit 0 of parameter No.1902) is set
                                to 0), parameter No.1905 is automatically set when input is
                                performed with the FSSB setting screen. When manual
                                setting 2 mode is selected for FSSB setting (when the FMD
                                parameter (bit 0 of parameter No.1902) is set to 1),
                                parameter No.1905 must be set directly. When a pulse
                                module is used, a connector number must be set in the
                                corresponding parameter (No.1936 or No.1937).
                                               104
B–63090EN/02                                                             4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
                                      NOTE
                                       After these parameters have been set, the power must be
                                       turned off then back on for the settings to become effective.
                                      NOTE
                                        When automatic setting mode is selected for FSSB setting
                                        (when the FMD parameter (bit 0 of parameter No.1902) is
                                        set to 0), parameters No.1910 through No.1919 are
                                        automatically set when input is performed with the FSSB
                                        setting screen. When manual setting 2 mode is selected for
                                        FSSB setting (when the FMD parameter (bit 0 of parameter
                                        No.1902) is set to 1), parameter No.1910 through No.1919
                                        must be directly set.
                                                  105
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS                                                                            B–63090EN/02
              1           X            1
              2           Y            3             1–axis        1            0                X
              3           Z            4            amplifier
              4           A            2                           2            1                A
                                                     2–axis
                                                    amplifier      3            2                Y
M1 4 16 (M1)
                                                     1–axis
                                                                   5            3                Z
                                                    amplifier
M2 6 48 (M2)
7 40 (None)
8 40 (None)
9 40 (None)
10 40 (None)
CNC
              1           X            1
              2           Y            3             1–axis        1             0               X
              3           Z            4            amplifier
              4           A            2
                                                     2–axis        2             1               Y
                                                    amplifier      3             2               A
                                                     1–axis
                                                                   4             4               Z
                                                    amplifier
M1 5 16 (M1)
M2 6 48 (M2)
                                                                   7            40             (None)
                                                                   8            40             (None)
                                                                   9            40             (None)
                                                                   10           40             (None)
                                                    106
B–63090EN/02                                                               4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
1920 Controlled axis number for slave 1 (dedicated to the FSSB setting screen)
1921 Controlled axis number for slave 2 (dedicated to the FSSB setting screen)
1922 Controlled axis number for slave 3 (dedicated to the FSSB setting screen)
1923 Controlled axis number for slave 4 (dedicated to the FSSB setting screen)
1924 Controlled axis number for slave 5 (dedicated to the FSSB setting screen)
1925 Controlled axis number for slave 6 (dedicated to the FSSB setting screen)
1926 Controlled axis number for slave 7 (dedicated to the FSSB setting screen)
1927 Controlled axis number for slave 8 (dedicated to the FSSB setting screen)
1928 Controlled axis number for slave 9 (dedicated to the FSSB setting screen)
1929 Controlled axis number for slave 10 (dedicated to the FSSB setting screen)
                                      NOTE
                                       After these parameters have been set, the power must be
                                       turned off then back on for the settings to become effective.
                                      NOTE
                                       These parameters are set using the FSSB setting screen.
                                       So, these parameters should not normally have to be
                                       specified directly. These parameters need not be set in
                                       FSSB manual setting mode.
1931 Connector number for the first pulse module (dedicated to the FSSB setting screen)
1932 Connector number for the second pulse module (dedicated to the FSSB setting screen)
                                      NOTE
                                       After these parameters have been set, the power must be
                                       turned off then back on for the settings to become effective.
                                      NOTE
                                       These parameters are set using the FSSB setting screen.
                                       So, these parameters should not normally have to be
                                       specified directly. These parameters need not be set in
                                       FSSB manual setting 2 mode.
                                                     107
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS                                                                                B–63090EN/02
                                   NOTE
                                    After this parameter has been set, the power must be turned
                                    off then back on for the setting to become effective.
                                   NOTE
                                    This parameter is set using the FSSB setting screen. So,
                                    this parameter should not normally have to be specified
                                    directly. This parameter need not be set in FSSB manual
                                    setting 2 mode.
                                   NOTE
                                    After these parameters have been set, the power must be
                                    turned off then back on for the settings to become effective.
                                                 108
B–63090EN/02                                                                 4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
                                      NOTE
                                       When automatic setting mode is selected for FSSB setting
                                       (when bit 0 of parameter No.1902 is set to 0), these
                                       parameters are automatically set when input is performed
                                       with the FSSB setting screen. When manual setting 2 mode
                                       is selected for FSSB setting (when bit 0 of parameter
                                       No.1902 is set to 1), these parameters must be set directly.
1942 Safety speed of each axis for dual check safety function
                                      NOTE
                                        When this parameter has been set, the power must be
                                        turned off before operation is continued.
1943 Safety position (positive direction) of each axis for dual check safety function
1944 Safety position (negative direction) of each axis for dual check safety function
                                      NOTE
                                        When this parameter has been set, the power must be
                                        turned off before operation is continued.
                                                     109
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS                                                                                B–63090EN/02
                [Unit of data]
                                      Increment system                IS-A           IS-B          IS-C           Unit
                                  Linear axis (millimeter input)       0.01          0.001        0.0001          mm
                                  Linear axis (inch input)            0.001         0.0001        0.00001         inch
                                  Rotation axis                        0.01          0.001        0.0001          deg
                                  NOTE
                                    A machine position check is carried out on a linear axis. A
                                    machine position check is not performed on a rotation axis.
                                    A machine position check is carried out on an axis on which
                                    the reference position is established. A machine position
                                    check is not performed on an axis on which the reference
                                    position is not established.
1945 Safety input signal check timer for dual check safety function
                                  NOTE
                                    When this parameter has been set, the power must be
                                    turned off before operation is continued.
                                                  110
B–63090EN/02                                                             4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
1946 MCC shut–off test timer for dual check safety function
                                     NOTE
                                       When this parameter has been set, the power must be
                                       turned off before operation is continued.
                                     NOTE
                                       After this parameter is set, the power must be turned off
                                       then back on for the setting to become effective.
                                                   111
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS                                                                            B–63090EN/02
Parameters No.2000 to 2999 are for digital servo, The following parameters are not explained in this manual.
Refer to FANUC AC SERVO MOTOR α series PARAMETER MANUAL (B–65150E)
  No.    Data type                                                        Contents
 2000      Bit axis                                                   PGEX       PRMC           DGPR          PLC0
 2001      Bit axis      AMR7              AMR6       AMR5            AMR4        AMR3   AMR2   AMR1          AMR0
 2002      Bit axis      VFSE                                                     PFSE
 2003      Bit axis      V0FS              OVSC       BLEN            NPSP        PIEN   OBEN   TGAL
 2004      Bit axis                        DLY0                                   TRW1   TRW0    TIB0         TIA0
 2005      Bit axis     SFCM               BRKC                                                 FEED
 2006      Bit axis                        DCBE                       ACCF        SPVE   PKVE   SBSM          FCBL
 2007      Bit axis      FRCA              FAD
 2008      Bit axis      LAXD              PFBS       VCTM            SPPC        SPPR   VFBA   TNDM
 2009      Bit axis      BLST              BLCU                                          ADBL    IQOB         SERD
 2010      Bit axis      POLE                         HBBL            HBPE        BLTE   LINE
 2011      Bit axis                                   RCCL                                      FFALWY      SYNMOD
 2012      Bit axis     STNG                          VCM2            VCM1                      MSFE
 2013      Bit axis      APTG
 2014      Bit axis                                                       (Reserve)
 2015      Bit axis     BZNG               BLAT       TDOU                                      SSG1         PGTW
 2016      Bit axis                                                               K2VC                        ABNT
 2017      Bit axis      PK25              OVCR          RISC         HTNG                                    DBST
 2018      Bit axis      PFBC                                                                   MOVO          REVS
 2019      Bit axis      DPFB                                         SPSY
 2020     Word axis   Motor number
 2021     Word axis   Load inertia ratio
 2022     Word axis   Direction of motor rotation
 2023     Word axis   Number of velocity pulses
 2024     Word axis   Number of position pulses
 2028     Word axis   Position gain switching speed
 2029     Word axis   Effective speed for integral acceleration at low speed
 2030     Word axis   Effective speed for integral deceleration at low speed
 2033     Word axis   Position feedback pulse
 2034     Word axis   Damping control gain
 2039     Word axis   Second–stage acceleration for two–stage backlash acceleration
 2040     Word axis   Current loop integral gain (PK1)
 2041     Word axis   Current loop proportional gain (PK2)
 2042     Word axis   Current loop gain (PK3)
 2043     Word axis   Velocity loop integral gain (PK1V)
 2044     Word axis   Velocity loop proportional gain (PK2V)
 2045     Word axis   Velocity loop incomplete integral gain (PK3V)
 2046     Word axis   Velocity loop gain (PK4V)
 2047     Word axis   Observer parameter (POA1)
 2048     Word axis   Backlash acceleration
 2049     Word axis   Maximum amplitude for dual position feedback
 2050     Word axis   Observer parameter (POK1)
 2051     Word axis   Observer parameter (POK2)
 2053     Word axis   Current dead zone compensation (PPMAX)
 2054     Word axis   Current dead zone compensation (PDDP)
 2055     Word axis   Current dead zone compensation (PHYST)
 2056     Word axis   Counterectromotive force compensation (EMFCMP)
 2057     Word axis   Current phase lead compensation (PVPA)
 2058     Word axis   Current phase lead compensation (PALPH)
 2059     Word axis   Counterelectromotive force compensation (EMFBAS)
 2060     Word axis   Torque limit
                                                                112
B–63090EN/02                                                                          4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
                                                                  113
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS                                                                                       B–63090EN/02
                                                              114
B–63090EN/02                                                 4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
4.18
                                   #7       #6      #5       #4       #3      #2       #1       #0
PARAMETERS OF          3001        MHI                                       RWM
DI/DO
               [Data type] Bit
                   RWM RWD signal indicating that rewinding is in progress
                       0 : Output only when the tape reader is being rewound by the reset and
                           rewind signal RRW
                       1 : Output when the tape reader is being rewound or a program in
                           memory is being rewound by the reset and rewind signal RRW
                    MHI Exchange of strobe and completion signals for the M, S, T, and B codes
                        0 : Normal
                        1 : High–speed
                                   #7       #6      #5        #4      #3      #2       #1       #0
                       3002                                  IOV
                                   #7       #6       #5      #4      #3        #2      #1       #0
                                           MVX      DEC     DAU      DIT      ITX               ITL
                       3003
                                           MVX      DEC              DIT      ITX               ITL
                                          115
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS                                                                         B–63090EN/02
                                       #7      #6        #5        #4         #3        #2           #1    #0
                           3004                         OTH                                         BCY    BSL
                        BSL The block start interlock signal *BSL and cutting block start interlock
                            signal *CSL are:
                            0 : Disabled.
                            1 : Enabled.
                        BCY When more than one operation is performed by one block command such
                            as a canned cycle, the block start interlock signal *BSL is:
                            0 : Checked only at the beginning of the first cycle.
                            1 : Checked at the beginning of every cycle.
                                  NOTE
                                   This is enabled when the BSL parameter (bit 0 of parameter
                                   No.3004) is set to 1.
                                  WARNING
                                   For safety, usually set 0 to check the overtravel limit signal.
                                       #7      #6        #5        #4         #3         #2          #1     #0
                           3006                                                         EPS         EPN    GDC
                        EPS When a program is searched using the workpiece number search function,
                            it is started by:
                            0 : Automatic operation start signal ST (when automatic operation
                                 (memory operation) is started).
                            1 : Workpiece number search start signal EPNS <G025.7>. (Search is not
                                 started by ST.)
                           3010                     Time lag in strobe signals MF, SF, TF, and BF
                                              116
B–63090EN/02                                                              4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
                                  The time required to send strobe signals MF, SF, TF, and BF after the M, S,
                                  T, and B codes are sent, respectively.
M, S, T, B code
Delay time
                                     NOTE
                                      The time is counted in units of 8 ms. If the set value is not
                                      a multiple of eight, it is raised to the next multiple of eight.
                                      Example
                                      When 30 is set, 32 ms is assumed.
                                      When 32 is set, 32 ms is assumed.
                                      When 100 ie set, 104 ms is assumed.
M, S, T, B code
FIN sigal
                                     NOTE
                                      The time is counted in units of 8 ms. If the set value is not
                                      a multiple of eight, it is raised to the next multiple of eight.
                                      Example
                                      When 30 is set, 32 ms is assumed.
                                                    117
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS                                                                     B–63090EN/02
                                   NOTE
                                    Up to 5 digits can be specified in the S code
                                              118
B–63090EN/02                                                4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
4.19
PARAMETERS OF                        #7      #6      #5      #4       #3      #2      #1      #0
MDI, DISPLAY,          3100         COR                              FKY     SKY     CEM
                                NOTE
                                 Set this parameter when using the 9.5”/10.4” LCD (with ten
                                 soft keys). After this parameter has been set, the power must
                                 be turned off then back on for the setting to become
                                 effective.
                                NOTE
                                 Set this parameter when using the 7.2”/8.4” LCD (with seven
                                 soft keys). After this parameter has been set, the power must
                                 be turned off then back on for the setting to become
                                 effective.
                      COR Display
                          0 : Monochrome display
                          1 : Color display
                                NOTE
                                 When using the 8.4” LCD, set this bit to 1.
                                     #7      #6      #5      #4      #3      #2       #1      #0
                         3101                               BGD                      KBF
                                            119
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS                                                                   B–63090EN/02
                                 NOTE
                                  When KBF = 1, the contents of the key–in buffer can all be
                                       #7           #6    #5     #4     #3             #2     #1      #0
                                                   SPN   HNG    ITA     CHI           FRN    GRM     JPN
                          3102
                                      DTH          SPN   HNG    ITA     CHI           FRAN   GRM     JPN
                                       #7           #6   #5     #4       #3            #2     #1      #0
                          3119                                                               POR
                                       #7           #6   #5     #4       #3            #2     #1      #0
                          3190                                          HUN
                                 NOTE
                                   When this parameter has been set, the power must be
                                   turned off before operation is continued.
                                       #7           #6   #5     #4      #3             #2     #1      #0
                          3103                                                        NMH
                                                   120
B–63090EN/02                                               4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
                                    #7     #6       #5      #4      #3     #2       #1      #0
                       3104        DAC     DAL     DRC     DRL     PPD                     MCN
                              NOTE
                               When PPD is set to 1 and the absolute position display is
                               preset by one of the following, the relative position display is
                               also preset to the same value as the absolute position display:
                               1) The manual reference position return
                               2) Setting of a coordinate system by G92 (G50 for T series
                                  G code system A)
                              NOTE
                               When tool geometry compensation of the T system is to be
                               performed by shifting the coordinate system (with bit 4 (LGT)
                               of parameter No.5002 set to 0), the programmed position,
                               ignoring tool offset, is displayed (with this parameter set to
                               1), but the programmed position, ignoring tool geometry
                               compensation, cannot be displayed.
                                          121
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS                                                          B–63090EN/02
                                 NOTE
                                  When tool geometry compensation of the T system is to be
                                  performed by shifting the coordinate system (with bit 4 (LGT)
                                  of parameter No.5002 set to 0), the programmed position,
                                  ignoring tool offset, is displayed (with this parameter set to
                                  1), but the programmed position, ignoring tool geometry
                                  compensation, cannot be displayed.
                                      #7      #6      #5      #4     #3      #2      #1     #0
                                                                            DPS     PCF     DPF
                          3105
                                      SMF                                   DPS     PCF     DPF
                                 NOTE
                                  For each setting, movement along any axis other than those
                                  controlled by the CNC (see the description of parameter No.
                                  1010) is not reflected in the actual speed display.
                                 NOTE
                                  For the M series, the threading and synchronous feed option
                                  is required to display the actual spindle speed.
                       SMF During simplified synchronous control, movement along a slave axis is:
                           (See the parameter No.8311)
                           0 : Included in the actual speed display
                           1 : Not included in the actual speed display
                                             122
B–63090EN/02                                                 4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
                                    #7       #6       #5      #4      #3    #2     #1      #0
                                   OHS               SOV     OPH     SPD          GPL
                       3106
                                   OHS               SOV     OPH                  GPL
                              NOTE
                               This parameter is enabled only when bit 2 (DPS) of
                               parameter No.3105 is set to 1.
                                    #7       #6       #5      #4      #3     #2      #1     #0
                       3107        MDL                       SOR            DNC            NAM
                                            123
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS                                                                     B–63090EN/02
                                         #7       #6    #5     #4        #3         #2        #1              #0
                                        JSP      SLM           WCI
                          3108
                                        JSP      SLM           WCI      PCT
                                 NOTE
                                 1 This parameter is enabled only when the DPS parameter (bit
                                   2 of parameter No.3105) is set to 1.
                                 2 This is valid only for serial spindles.
                        JSP On the current position display screen and program check screen, jog feed is:
                            0 : Not displayed.
                            1 : Displayed.
                                 NOTE
                                  In manual operation mode, the jog feedrate is displayed. In
                                  automatic operation mode, the dry run feedrate is displayed.
                                  In each case, the feedrate to which a manual feedrate
                                  override has been applied is displayed.
                                               JOG F      8000         PART COUNT                15
                                               RUN TIME   1H17M        CYCLE TIME                1H15S
                                               ACT.F      1000 MM/M
                                               MEM STRT MTN ***       12:34:59
                                    Jog
                                               [     ] [      ] [        ] [             ]   [            ]
                                    feedrate
                                                124
B–63090EN/02                                                 4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
                                    #7      #6       #5      #4       #3       #2      #1       #0
                                                    RHD                       IKY     DWT
                        3109
                                                    RHD                       IKY
                               NOTE
                                This parameter is enabled when the INH parameter (bit 2 of
                                parameter No.7100) is 1.
                                    #7      #6       #5      #4       #3       #2      #1      #0
                                                                              AHC              OFA
                        3110
                                                                              AHC
                                   #7       #6      #5       #4       #3       #2      #1       #0
                        3111       NPA     OPS     OPM                        SVP     SPS      SVS
                                           125
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS                                                             B–63090EN/02
                                  NOTE
                                   When this parameter is set, the power must be turned off
                                   before operation is continued.
                                  NOTE
                                   If SGD is set to 1, no graphic display other than servo
                                   waveform display is done.
                                             126
B–63090EN/02                                                       4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
                              NOTE
                               When the values of MS0 and MS1 are changed, all preserved
                               external operator message history data is cleared.
                                   #7              #6       #5      #4         #3        #2       #1      #0
                       3114                       ICS      IUS     IMS        ISY       IOF      IPR     IPO
                     IPO When the        POS       function key is pressed while the position display screen
                           is being displayed:
                           0 : The screen is changed.
                           1 : The screen is not changed.
                     IPR When the       PROG       function key is pressed while the program screen is being
                           displayed:
                           0 : The screen is changed.
                           1 : The screen is not changed.
                    IMS When the        MESSAGE    function key is pressed while the message screen is being
                           displayed:
                           0 : The screen is changed.
                           1 : The screen is not changed.
                                                  127
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS                                                                 B–63090EN/02
                                       #7       #6          #5          #4     #3     #2     #1     #0
                                                                              NDFx   SFMx   NDAx   NDPx
                           3115
                                               D10x                           NDFx          NDAx   NDPx
                                  NOTE
                                   Even if the PCF parameter (bit 1 of parameter No.3105) is
                                   set to 0, so as to add PMC controlled axis movement data
                                   to the actual speed display, the movement data for a PMC
                                   controlled axis for which NDFx is set to 1 is not added to the
                                   actual speed display.
                                               128
B–63090EN/02                                                4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
                                NOTE
                                  The value of this parameter set for path 1 is valid. The
                                  values of loader are invalid.
                                    #7      #6      #5       #4      #3      #2       #1      #0
                         3117       P9D                                              SPP
                                    P9D                                              SPP     SMS
                                NOTE
                                 When this parameter is set, the power must be turned off
                                 before operation is continued.
                                           129
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS                                                                            B–63090EN/02
                               1 : The value calculated from the spindle motor speed (the same as the
                                   spindle speed displayed on the operating monitor screen).
                                       #7        #6        #5        #4          #3         #2         #1       #0
                                      NVG                            F2K        TPA        DDS        POR
                           3119
                                      NVG                                       TPA        DDS        POR
                                  NOTE
                                   When this parameter is set, the power must be turned off
                                   before operation is continued.
                                       Time from the output of an alarm to the termination of sampling (waveform diag-
                           3120
                                       nosis function)
                                               130
B–63090EN/02                                                           4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
3127 D25
                                      NOTE
                                       Set these parameters when using the display with seven soft
                                       keys.
                                      NOTE
                                      1 For characters and codes, see the correspondence table in
                                        Appendix 1.
                                      2 When code 0 is specified, 1 or 2 is displayed.
                                                  131
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS                                                                             B–63090EN/02
3134 Axis display order on workpiece coordinate system screen and workpiece shift screen
                                                 132
B–63090EN/02                                                 4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
                              NOTE
                              1 These parameters are valid when the loader control
                                function is used.
                              2 Set the parameters for the machine and loader separately.
                              3 For details of character codes, see Appendix A.
               [Example] When the names of machine and loader are specified as NC and
                         LOADER, respectively.
                          (1) Setting for machine                   (2) Setting for loader
                              Parameter 3141 = 78 (N)                   Parameter 3141 = 76 (L)
                              Parameter 3142 = 67 (C)                   Parameter 3142 = 79 (O)
                              Parameter 3143 = 32 (Space)               Parameter 3143 = 65 (A)
                              Parameter 3144 = 32 (Space)               Parameter 3144 = 68 (D)
                              Parameter 3145 = 32 (Space)               Parameter 3145 = 69 (E)
                              Parameter 3146 = 32 (Space)               Parameter 3146 = 82 (R)
                              Parameter 3147 = 32 (Space)               Parameter 3147 = 32 (Space)
                                         133
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS                                                                              B–63090EN/02
3151 Number of the axis for which the first load meter for the servo motor is used
3152 Number of the axis for which the second load meter for the servo motor is used
3153 Number of the axis for which the third load meter for the servo motor is used
3154 Number of the axis for which the fourth load meter for servo motor is used
                                    NOTE
                                      When this parameter has been set, the power must be
                                      turned off before operation is continued.
                                                 134
B–63090EN/02                                                           4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
                                       NOTE
                                       1 If two or more points are pressed during a sampling period,
                                         it is assumed that a mid point is pressed.
                                       2 If a C executer application or the like has a touch panel drag
                                         (move in pressed state) function, set this parameter to 0.
                                       3 In open CNC, the parameter is valid just for CNC screen
                                         display function.
                            TRA If a point on the touch panel is kept pressed for a time specified in
                                parameter No. 3197 or longer,
                                0 : P/S alarm 5303 is not raised.
                                1 : P/S alarm 5303 is raised.
                                       NOTE
                                       1 If an C executer application or the like has a touch panel
                                         repeat (continue pressing) function, set this parameter to 0.
                                       2 In open CNC, the parameter is valid just for the CNC screen
                                         display function.
                                       NOTE
                                         This improvement is valid if the hardware is equipped with
                                         a separate buzzer.
                             TB2 If a buzzer is provided and if bit 3 (TBZ) of parameter No. 3192 is set to 1,
                                 0 : Pressing any point on the touch panel causes the buzzer to sound. If
                                      any point is kept pressed, the buzzer continues sounding.
                                 1 : The buzzer sounds when the pressing on the touch panel is recognized
                                      as a key.
                                                   135
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS                                                            B–63090EN/02
                                      #7       #6       #5    #4        #3     #2      #1      #0
                          3202                PSR      CPD    NE9      OSR    CND      OLV     NE8
                                             136
B–63090EN/02                                               4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
                              NOTE
                                If this parameter is set, a protected program is also
                                displayed.
                                   #7      #6       #5      #4      #3     #2      #1      #0
                       3203       MCL     MER      MZE
                              NOTE
                               When MER is set to 0, the program is deleted if the
                               end–of–record mark (%) is read and executed. (The mark %
                               is automatically inserted at the end of a program.)
                                         137
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS                                                          B–63090EN/02
                                      #7      #6     #5      #4      #3      #2      #1      #0
                          3204               MKP                            EXK             PAR
                                 NOTE
                                  The [C–EXT] soft key is used to select an operation on the
                                  program screen. This soft key enables the entry of “(”, “)”,
                                  and “@” using soft keys. This soft key is useful when using
                                  the small MDI keyboard, which does not have the “(”, “)”, and
                                  “@” keys.
                      MKP When M02, M30, or EOR(%) is executed during MDI operation, the
                          created MDI program is:
                          0 : Erased automatically.
                          1 : Not erased automatically.
                                 NOTE
                                  If the MER parameter (bit 6 of parameter No.3203) is 1,
                                  executing the last block provides a choice of whether to
                                  automatically erase a created program.
                                      #7      #6     #5      #4      #3      #2      #1      #0
                          3205       MCK                    OSC     PNS     CMO     CHG     COL
                                             138
B–63090EN/02                                               4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
                                   #7     #6       #5      #4      #3       #2     #1       #0
                       3206                               PHS                      MIF
                                   #7      #6      #5      #4      #3       #2         #1    #0
                       3207                                                                 OM4
                              NOTE
                                When this parameter has been set, the power must be
                                turned off before operation is continued.
                                   #7      #6      #5      #4      #3       #2      #1       #0
                       3208                                                        COK      SKY
                              NOTE
                              1 The setting for loader is ignored.
                              2 If this parameter is set to 1, screen erasure by the CAN +
                                FUNCTION key is enabled, irrespective of the setting of
                                parameter No. 3123.
                                         139
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS                                                                       B–63090EN/02
                                        #7      #6        #5        #4        #3        #2         #1     #0
                           3209                                                                          MPD
3210 Password
                                   NOTE
                                   1 The state where password 0 0 and password 0 keyword is
                                     referred to as the locked state. When an attempt is made to
                                     modify the password by MDI input operation in this state, the
                                     warning message “WRITE PROTECTED” is displayed to
                                     indicate that the password cannot be modified. When an
                                     attempt is made to modify the password with G10
                                     (programmable parameter input), P/S alarm No.231 is issued.
                                   2 When the value of the password is not 0, the parameter
                                     screen does not display the password. Care must be taken
                                     in setting a password.
3211 Keyword
                                   NOTE
                                    The value set in this parameter is not displayed. When the
                                    power is turned off, this parameter is set to 0.
                                               140
B–63090EN/02                                                             4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
                                     CAUTION
                                       Once a safety parameter is locked, the lock must be
                                       unlocked or a memory all clear operation must be carried
                                       out to change the safety parameter. In addition, the cipher
                                       for safety parameter cannot be used. Take great care when
                                       setting the cipher for safety parameter.
                                                   141
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS                                                                              B–63090EN/02
                           3241
                                             Character blinking in the AI look–ahead control mode (first character)
                           3242
                                         Character blinking in the AI look–ahead control mode (second character)
                           3243
                                            Character blinking in the AI look–ahead control mode (third character)
                           3244
                                            Character blinking in the AI look–ahead control mode (fourth character)
                           3245
                                             Character blinking in the AI look–ahead control mode (fifth character)
                           3246
                                            Character blinking in the AI look–ahead control mode (sixth character)
                           3247
                                         Character blinking in the AI look–ahead control mode (seventh character)
                                  NOTE
                                  1 Set character codes according to the character code list in
                                    Appendix A.
                                  2 When 0 is set, AIAPC blinks.
                                       #7          #6         #5         #4        #3         #2         #1            #0
                           3260                                                                                       LCH
                                  NOTE
                                    When this parameter has been set, the power must be
                                    turned off before operation is continued.
                                                 142
B–63090EN/02                                                          4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
                                      NOTE
                                        When this parameter has been set, the power must be
                                        turned off before operation is continued.
                                      NOTE
                                        If the setting is greater than the number of actually
                                        connected units, MDI of the last LCD unit is selected.
                                      NOTE
                                        The setting cannot be changed from MDI or the like.
                                           #7     #6        #5         #4       #3         #2        #1        #0
                              3290        KEY    MCM                  IWZ      WZO        MCV       GOF       WOF
                                                 143
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS                                                           B–63090EN/02
                      WZO Setting a workpiece zero point offset value by MDI key input is:
                           0 : Not disabled
                           1 : Disabled
                       IWZ Setting a workpiece zero point offset value or workpiece shift value
                           (T–series) by MDI key input in the automatic operation activation or halt
                           state is:
                           0 : Not disabled
                           1 : Disabled
                      MCM The setting of custom macros by MDI key operation is:
                           0 : Enabled regardless of the mode.
                           1 : Enabled only in the MDI mode.
                      KEY For memory protection keys:
                           0 : The KEY1, KEY2, KEY3, and KEY4 signals are used.
                           1 : Only the KEY1 signal is used.
                                 NOTE
                                   The functions of the signals depend on whether KEY=0 or
                                   KEY=1.
                                   When KEY = 0:
                                 – KEY1: Enables a tool offset value and a workpiece zero
                                          point offset value to be input.
                                 – KEY2: Enables setting data and macro variables to be input.
                                 – KEY3: Enables program registration and editing.
                                 – KEY4: Enables PMC data (counter and data table) to be
                                          input.
                                   When KEY = 1:
                                 – KEY1: Enables program registration and editing, and
                                         enables PMC parameter input.
                                 – KEY2 to KEY4: Not used
                                      #7      #6     #5       #4      #3      #2      #1      #0
                          3291                                                               WPT
                                      #7      #6      #5      #4      #3      #2      #1      #0
                          3292        PK5
                                            144
B–63090EN/02                                                       4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
3294 Start number of tool offset values whose input by MDI is disabled
3295 Number of tool offset values (from the start number) whose input by MDI is disabled
                                            145
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS                                                           B–63090EN/02
4.20
                                       #7     #6      #5       #4      #3     #2       #1      #0
PARAMETERS OF                         GSC    GSB                                      FCD      DPI
PROGRAMS                  3401
                                                     ABS       MAB                             DPI
                                 NOTE
                                 1 When FCD = 1:
                                   If the block containing a G command (G98, G99) does not
                                   include an F command, the last F command specified is
                                   assumed to be specified in the G command mode of the
                                   block.
                                   Example
                                   N1 G99 ;
                                   N2 Faaaa G98 ; - Faaaa is assumed to be specified in the
                                                       G98 mode.
                                   N3 Fbbbb ;        - Fbbbb is assumed to be specified in the
                                                       G98 mode.
                                   N4 G99 ;          - Fbbbb is assumed to be specified in the
                                                       G99 mode.
                                 2 In G code system B or C, G98 and G99 function are specified
                                   in G94 and G95.
                                 NOTE
                                  ABS is valid when MAB, #4 of parameter No.3401, is set to 1.
                                            146
B–63090EN/02                                                     4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
                                         #7       #6    #5       #4      #3        #2       #1      #0
                                         G23     CLR                     G91                        G01
                           3402
                                         G23     CLR                     G91      G19      G18      G01
                                         #7       #6    #5       #4       #3       #2       #1       #0
                           3403                  AD2    CIR
                                  NOTE
                                  1 When 1 is set, specifying two or more G codes of the same
                                    group in a block will also result in an alarm being issued.
                                  2 Up to three M codes can be specified in a single block, when
                                    bit 7 (M3B) of parameter No.3404 is set to 1.
                                                 147
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS                                                            B–63090EN/02
                                    #7        #6     #5       #4       #3      #2       #1      #0
                                    M3B      EOR     M02      M30             SBP      POL
                          3404
                                    M3B      EOR     M02      M30             SBP      POL     NOP
                                            148
B–63090EN/02                                              4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
                                   #7      #6      #5      #4      #3      #2      #1      #0
                                  QAB     QLG     DDP     CCR      G36    PPS     DWL     AUX
                       3405
                                                                                  DWL     AUX
                              NOTE
                               This parameter is valid when bit 7 (QAB) of parameter
                               No.3405 = 0.
                    QAB When the passing–point signal output function is used, address “,Q”
                        specifies:
                        0 : Remaining distance to be traveled
                        1 : Coordinate value of the longest axis
                                         149
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS                                                                           B–63090EN/02
                                          #7       #6      #5        #4         #3          #2        #1      #0
                                          C07              C05       C04        C03         C02       C01
                             3406
                                          C07              C05       C04        C03         C02       C01
                                                                                                              C16
                             3408
                                                                                C19         C18       C17     C16
                                          CFH
                             3409
                                          CFH
                                    NOTE
                                     When the set value is 0, the difference of radii is not checked.
                                     In the HPCC mode, a check is made for a difference in the arc
                                     radius even if the set value is “0” (with allowable limit = 0).
                                                  150
B–63090EN/02                                                             4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
L L
                                      NOTE
                                      1 The specification of a minimum value that exceeds the
                                        specified maximum value is invalid.
                                      2 When there is only one data item, set the following: minimum
                                        value = maximum value.
                                                   151
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS                                                               B–63090EN/02
                                      #7       #6       #5      #4       #3      #2       #1       #0
                                                               NPS      CQD
                          3450
                                      BDX                               CQD                       AUP
                                 NOTE
                                  For the T series, a decimal point and negative sign are
                                  supported for commands for the second miscellaneous
                                  function, regardless of the setting made with this parameter.
                       CQD The method used for determining the amount of travel in circular
                           interpolation is:
                           0 : Series 16 type.
                           1 : Series 15 type.
                       NPS A block that contains M98 Pxxx or M99, and which contains no addresses
                           other than O and N functions:
                           0 : As a one–block NC statement involving no movement.
                               (A single–block stop is caused.)
                           1 : As a macro statement.
                               (A single–block stop is not caused. Moreover, the block is not
                               regarded as a block involving no movement in tool–tip radius
                               compensation mode.)
                       BDX A decimal point specified with address B is handled:
                           0 : In the conventional way.
                           1 : In the same way as in a system equipped with the second auxiliary
                               function.
                               In a system without second auxiliary function, the decimal point specified
                               with address B can be handled as in a system equipped with the second
                               auxiliary function. The following parameters can be used:
                               D Bit 0 (AUP) of parameter No. 3450
                               D Bit 0 (AUX) of parameter No. 3405
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0
                          3451
                                                               NBN      CCK      SDP              GQS
                                              152
B–63090EN/02                                                4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
                                   #7       #6      #5       #4      #3       #2      #1       #0
                                                                                              CRD
                        3453
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0
                        3455
                                                                                              AXD
                                          153
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS                                                                       B–63090EN/02
                                 NOTE
                                 1 This parameter is valid if bit 0 (DPI) of parameter No. 3401
                                   is set to 0.
                                 2 Because some addresses (such as R and K) are not related
                                   to an axis, setting this parameter for all axes is not equivalent
                                   to setting bit 0 (DPI) of parameter No. 3401 to 1.
                          3460
                                                       Address for second miscellaneous function
                                                 154
B–63090EN/02                                                             4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
4.21
                                          #7        #6         #5         #4        #3         #2         #1         #0
PARAMETERS OF                                                                                            EPC
PITCH ERROR                   3601
COMPENSATION
                                     NOTE
                                       When this parameter has been set, the power must be
                                       turned off before operation is continued.
                                     NOTE
                                       When this parameter has been set, the power must be
                                       turned off before operation is continued.
                                     NOTE
                                      The function of both–direction pitch error compensation is
                                      required.
                                          Number of the pitch error compensation position for the reference position for
                              3620
                                          each axis
                                     NOTE
                                      When this parameter is set, the power must be turned off
                                      before operation is continued.
                                                  155
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS                                                                            B–63090EN/02
                               Set the number of the pitch error compensation position for the reference
                               position for each axis.
                                                     3
                                                     2
                                                     1
                                                                                          Pitch error compensation
                                                         Reference position               position (number)
                                                          –1
                                                          –2
                                  NOTE
                                   When this parameter is set, the power must be turned off
                                   before operation is continued.
                                  NOTE
                                   When this parameter is set, the power must be turned off
                                   before operation is continued.
                                               156
B–63090EN/02                                                               4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
                                      NOTE
                                       When this parameter is set, the power must be turned off
                                       before operation is continued.
3624 Interval between pitch error compensation positions for each axis
                                      NOTE
                                       When this parameter is set, the power must be turned off
                                       before operation is continued.
                                                    157
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS                                                                                           B–63090EN/02
                                                            158
B–63090EN/02                                                             4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
+4
+3
                                            +2
                      Reference position
                                            +1
                                                 0
     –400      –300      –200       –100                     100      200        300        400   (mm)
                                                  –1
–2
–3
–4
                                                       159
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS                                                                                     B–63090EN/02
                                                         45.0                                          315.0
                                                                         (61)           (68)
                                                                                               (60)
                                                               (62)                               (67)
                                                 90.0                                                          270.0
                                                                  (+)
(63) (66)
                                                                         (64)           (65)
                                                        135.0                                          225.0
180.0
+3 Reference position
+2
                                      +1
                                                                                                          Machine coordinate
                                             0                                                            0
            90   135 180 225 270 315              45      90     135 180 225 270 315                           45 (deg)
                                      –1
                                      –2
–3
–4
                                                  160
B–63090EN/02                                                               4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
3625 Travel distance per revolution in pitch error compensation of rotation axis type
                                      NOTE
                                        When this parameter has been set, the power must be
                                        turned off before operation is continued.
                                      NOTE
                                       If 0 is set, the travel distance per revolution becomes 360
                                       degrees.
                                          Number of pitch error compensation point at the farthest end in the negative
                               3626       direction (for movement in the negative direction)
                                      NOTE
                                        When this parameter has been set, the power must be
                                        turned off before operation is continued.
                                      NOTE
                                      1 For a movement in the positive direction, set the
                                        compensation point number at the farthest end in the
                                        negative direction in parameter No. 3621.
                                      2 A set of compensation data items for a single axis should not
                                        be set to lie astride 1023 and 3000.
                                                    161
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS                                                                              B–63090EN/02
                                  NOTE
                                    When this parameter has been set, the power must be
                                    turned off before operation is continued.
                                      Number of pitch error compensation point in the reference position if pitch error
                                      compensation is carried out on an axis of Cs contour control on the slave side
                                      during simple synchronous spindle control (for the first spindle)
                           3661
                                      Number of pitch error compensation point in the reference position if pitch error
                                      compensation is carried out on an axis of Cs contour control on the slave side
                                      during simple synchronous spindle control (for the second spindle)
                           3662
                                      Number of pitch error compensation point at the farthest end in the negative
                                      direction if pitch error compensation is carried out on an axis of Cs contour con-
                                      trol on the slave side during simple synchronous spindle control (for the first
                           3666       spindle)
                                      Number of pitch error compensation point at the farthest end in the negative
                                      direction if pitch error compensation is carried out on an axis of Cs contour con-
                                      trol on the slave side during simple synchronous spindle control (for the second
                           3667       spindle)
                                                162
B–63090EN/02                                                              4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
                                         Number of pitch error compensation point at the farthest end in the positive
                                         direction if pitch error compensation is carried out on an axis of Cs contour con-
                                         trol on the slave side during simple synchronous spindle control (for the first
                              3671       spindle)
                                         Number of pitch error compensation point at the farthest end in the positive
                                         direction if pitch error compensation is carried out on an axis of Cs contour con-
                                         trol on the slave side during simple synchronous spindle control (for the second
                              3672       spindle)
                                     NOTE
                                       When this parameter has been set, the power must be
                                       turned off before operation is continued.
                                     NOTE
                                       When this parameter has been set, the power must be
                                       turned off before operation is continued.
                                                   163
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS                                                                              B–63090EN/02
                                   NOTE
                                   1 This parameter is valid if pitch error compensation on an axis
                                     of Cs contour control on the salve side during simple
                                     synchronous spindle control is carried out just for the slave
                                     axis (bit 1 of parameter No. 3601 is set to 1).
                                   2 The number of the compensation point at the farthest end in
                                     the negative direction for a movement in the positive
                                     direction is set in parameters No. 3666 to No. 3669.
                                   3 A set of compensation data items for a single axis cannot be
                                     set to lie astride 1023 and 3000 or astride 2599 and 5599.
                                   NOTE
                                     When this parameter has been set, the power must be
                                     turned off before operation is continued.
                                                 164
B–63090EN/02                               4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
               NOTE
                 This parameter is valid if pitch error compensation on an
                 axis of Cs contour control on the slave side during simple
                 synchronous spindle control is carried out just on the slave
                 axis (bit 1 of parameter No. 3601 is set to 1).
                           165
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS                                                                B–63090EN/02
4.22
PARAMETERS OF                         #7      #6       #5      #4       #3      #2          #1     #0
SPINDLE CONTROL           3700                                                             NRF
                                      #7      #6       #5      #4       #3      #2         #1      #0
                          3701                                 SS2                         ISI
                                 NOTE
                                  When this parameter is set, the power must be turned off
                                  before operation is continued.
                         ISI The serial interface for the first and second spindles are:
                             0 : Used.
                             1 : Not used.
                                 NOTE
                                  This parameter is valid when the spindle serial output option
                                  is provided. It is used when the CNC is started with serial
                                  interface control for the first and second serial spindles
                                  disabled temporarily (for example, for CNC startup
                                  adjustment). Usually, it should be set to 0.
                                  If this parameter is set to 1 when using the serial spindle and
                                  analog spindle at the same time, the analog spindle is set the
                                  first axis.
                                 NOTE
                                  This parameter is valid, when the spindle serial output option
                                  is provided and parameter ISI(bit 1 of parameter No.3701)is 0.
                                   1 Confirmation of connection of the second serial spindle
                                       amplifier, and communication with it
                                   2 Control of the second spindle during asynchronous
                                       control (SIND2)
                                  The spindle synchronization function and simplified spindle
                                  synchronization function require that two serial spindles be
                                  connected in advance. Before using these functions,
                                  ensure that this parameter is set to 1 (the parameter is not
                                  set automatically).
                                  When this parameter is set, it is also necessary to set the
                                  serial spindle parameter for the second spindle.
                                             166
B–63090EN/02                                              4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
                                   #7      #6     #5      #4      #3        #2   #1      #0
                       3702                                      OR2       OR1
                              NOTE
                                When this parameter is set, the power must be turned off
                                before operation is continued.
                                   #7      #6     #5      #4      #3       #2    #1      #0
                                                                 MPP
                       3703
                              NOTE
                                When this parameter is set, the power must be turned off
                                before operation is continued.
                              NOTE
                               If this parameter is set to 1, set parameters No. 3781 to No.
                               3782 as well.
                                   #7      #6      #5      #4     #3       #2    #1      #0
                       3704                       SSY     SSS
                              NOTE
                                When this parameter has been set, the power must be
                                turned off before operation is continued.
                                          167
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS                                                             B–63090EN/02
                                  NOTE
                                   For the T series, this parametar is enabled when bit 4 (EVS)
                                   of parameter No.3705 is set to 1.
                                   For the M series, SF is not output:
                                    (1) For an S command used to specify maximum spindle
                                        speed clamping (G92S–––;) in constant surface speed
                                        control mode
                                    (2) When bit 5 (NSF) of parameter No.3705 is set to 1
                                  NOTE
                                    If the function of constant surface speed control or bit 4
                                    (GTT) of parameter No. 3706 is specified, this parameter is
                                    invalid.
                                              168
B–63090EN/02                                                    4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
                                    NOTE
                                     The output of S codes and SF for an S command in constant
                                     surface speed control mode (G96), or for an S command
                                     used to specify maximum spindle speed clamping
                                     (G50S–––;) depends on the setting of bit 0 (ESF) of
                                     parameter No.3705.
                                         #7     #6      #5       #4       #3     #2       #1      #0
                                        TCW    CWM     ORM                               PG2     PG1
                             3706
                                        TCW    CWM     ORM      GTT                      PG2     PG1
                                               169
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS                                                             B–63090EN/02
                                  NOTE
                                  1 The gear selection method differs as described below. For
                                    details, refer to the description of spindle control in the
                                    connection manual (function part).
                                    Type M:
                                      The CNC determines a proper gear from the parameter
                                      setting and S command value, and requests the PMC to
                                      specify the gear and its switching.
                                      In addition, spindle control is exercised according to a
                                      gear selected by the CNC.
                                    Type T:
                                      The CNC exercises spindle control according to a gear
                                      selected by the PMC.
                                  2 When the constant surface speed control option is selected,
                                    type T is selected, regardless of whether this parameter is
                                    specified.
                                  3 When type T spindle gear switching is selected, the following
                                    parameters have no effect:
                                      No.3705#2 SGB, No.3751, No.3752, No.3705#3 SGT,
                                      No.3761, No.3762, No.3705#6 SFA, No.3735, No.3736
                                    On the other hand, parameter No. 3744 becomes usable for
                                    ordinary spindle control.
                                        #7      #6     #5       #4       #3        #2   #1      #0
                           3707                                                         P22     P21
                                  NOTE
                                   This parameter is valid when the multi–spindle control option
                                   is selected.
                                               170
B–63090EN/02                                              4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
                                   #7      #6      #5      #4      #3      #2      #1       #0
                                          TSO     SOC     SVD                      SAT     SAR
                       3708
                                          TSO     SOC                                      SAR
                              NOTE
                               When thread cutting blocks are consecutive, the spindle
                               speed arrival signal is not checked for the second and
                               subsequent thread cutting blocks.
                    SVD When the SIND signal is on, the detection of spindle speed fluctuation is:
                        0 : Disabled
                        1 : Enabled
                    SOC During constant surface speed control (G96 mode), the speed clamp by
                        the maximum spindle speed clamp command (M series: G92 S_; T series:
                        G50 S_;) is carried out:
                        0 : Before spindle speed override.
                        1 : After spindle speed override.
                        If this parameter is set to 0, the spindle speed may exceed the maximum
                        spindle speed (numeric value following S in G92 S_; (M series) or G50
                        S_; (T series)).
                        If this parameter is set to 1, the spindle speed is limited to the maximum
                        spindle speed.
                        The spindle speed is limited to the upper limit of spindle speed specified
                        in parameter No. 3772, irrespective of the setting of this parameter.
                    TSO During a threading or tapping cycle, the spindle override is:
                        0 : Disabled (tied to 100%).
                        1 : Enabled.
                              NOTE
                                During rigid tapping, the override is tied to 100%,
                                irrespective of the setting of this parameter.
                                   #7     #6       #5      #4      #3      #2       #1      #0
                                                                  MRS      MSI     RSC     SAM
                       3709
                                                          SMC                      RSC
                                         171
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS                                                                          B–63090EN/02
                                 RSC In the constant surface speed control mode, the surface speed of a rapid
                                     traverse block is calculated:
                                     0 : In accordance with the coordinates of the end point.
                                     1 : In accordance with the current value, as in cutting feed.
                                 MSI In multi–spindle control, the SIND signal is valid
                                     0 : Only when the first spindle is valid (SIND signal for the 2nd, 3rd
                                         spindle becomes ineffective)
                                     1 : For each spindle irrespective of whether the spindle is selected (Each
                                         spindle has its own SIND signal).
                                 MRS When the S 12–bit code signals and actual spindle speed signals are
                                     output in multi–spindle control:
                                     0: Signals common to the first and second spindles are used. In this case,
                                         information about a spindle selected by the spindle selection signal
                                         (SWS1–SWS3<G027#0–#2>) and SWS4<G026#3>) is output.
                                     1: Information about each of the first and second spindles is output on
                                         individual signals.
             Signal                            When MRS is set to 0                     When MRS is set to 1
S 12–bit code signals            First spindle (SWS1 = 1)                        First spindle
R01O–R12O<F036,F037>             Second spindle (SWS1 = 0, SWS2 = 1)
Actual spindle speed signals
AR0–AR15<F040,F041>
S 12–bit code signals 2                                –                         Second spindle
R01O2–R12O2<F200,F201>
Actual spindle speed signals 2
AR200–AR215<F202,F203>
                                         NOTE
                                         1 To use this parameter, the multi–spindle control option and
                                           serial spindle option are required.
                                         2 To use the actual spindle speed signals, the actual spindle
                                           speed output option is required.
                                         NOTE
                                           This function cannot be used together with any of bit 4
                                           (GTT) of parameter No. 3706, constant surface speed
                                           control, or multi–spindle control.
                                                       172
B–63090EN/02                                                                 4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
                                             #7         #6         #5         #4        #3         #2         #1        #0
                                 3715                                                                                  NSAx
3730 Data used for adjusting the gain of the analog output of spindle speed
                                        NOTE
                                         This parameter needs not to be set for serial spindles.
                                            Compensation value for the offset voltage of the analog output of the spindle
                                 3731
                                            speed
                                                       173
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS                                                                               B–63090EN/02
                                     NOTE
                                     This parameter need not to be set for serial spindles.
                                           The spindle speed during spindle orientation or the spindle motor speed
                              3732
                                           during spindle gear shift
                              3735
                                                           Minimum clamp speed of the spindle motor
                                     NOTE
                                       If the function of constant surface speed control or bit 4
                                       (GTT) of parameter No. 3706 is specified, this parameter is
                                       invalid.
                                                   174
B–63090EN/02                                                                     4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
                                        3736
                                                                  Maximum clamp speed of the spindle motor
                                               NOTE
                                                 If the function of constant surface speed control or bit 4
                                                 (GTT) of parameter No. 3706 is specified, this parameter is
                                                 invalid.
                                                 In this case, the maximum clamp speed of spindle motor
                                                 cannot be specified. However, the maximum spindle speed
                                                 can be specified by the following parameters.
                                                 Parameter No.3772 (for the first axis)
                                                 Parameter No.3802 (for the second axis)
3740 Time elapsed prior to checking the spindle speed arrival signal
                                                           175
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS                                                                            B–63090EN/02
                                      NOTE
                                        If a type–T gear shift scheme is selected for the M series
                                        (with the constant surface speed control option installed or
                                        parameter GTT (bit 4 of parameter No. 3706) = 1),
                                        parameter No. 3744 is usable also in the M series.
                                        Note, however, that, even in this case, only up to three main
                                        gear stages are usable for rigid tapping.
                               3751
                                                   Spindle motor speed when switching from gear 1 to gear 2
                               3752
                                                   Spindle motor speed when switching from gear 2 to gear 3
                                                   176
B–63090EN/02                                                                  4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
                                                                                                     Spindle speed
                                            Gear 1              Gear 2             Gear 3            command
                                            max.                max.               max               (S command)
                                            speed               speed              speed
                                            parameter           parameter          parameter
                                            No.3741             No.3742            No.3743
                                    3761
                                                     Spindle speed when switching from gear 1 to gear 2 during tapping
                                    3762
                                                     Spindle speed when switching from gear 2 to gear 3 during tapping
                                                        177
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS                                                                                 B–63090EN/02
Fig.4.22 (d) Spindle Motor Speed at Gear 1–2/2–3 Change Point during Tapping
                                         NOTE
                                          When 0 is set, constant surface speed control is always
                                          applied to the X–axis. In this case, specifying P in a G96
                                          block has no effect on the constant surface speed control.
3771 Minimum spindle speed in constant surface speed control mode (G96)
                                                      178
B–63090EN/02                                                              4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
                                      NOTE
                                      1 For M series, this parameter is valid if the function of constant
                                        surface speed control is provided.
                                      2 When the constant surface speed control option is selected,
                                        the spindle speed is clamped at the maximum speed,
                                        regardless of whether the G96 mode or G97 mode is specified.
                                      3 When 0 is set in this parameter, the speed of the spindle is
                                        not clamped.
                                      4 When spindle speed command control is applied using the
                                        PMC, this parameter has no effect, and the spindle speed is
                                        not clamped.
                                      5 When the multi–spindle control option is selected (T series),
                                        set the maximum speed for each spindle in the following
                                        parameters:
                                        Parameter No.3772: Sets the maximum speed for the first
                                        spindle.
                                        Parameter No.3802: Sets the maximum speed for the
                                        second spindle.
                                      NOTE
                                        When this parameter has been set, the power must be
                                        turned off before operation is continued.
                                                   179
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS                                                                      B–63090EN/02
                                  NOTE
                                  1 This parameter is valid if bit 3 (MPP) of parameter No. 3703
                                    is set to 1.
                                  2 If this parameter is set to 0, the corresponding spindle
                                    cannot be selected by a P code.
                                  3 Identical P code values cannot be used for different
                                    spindles. (Identical P code values cannot be used even if the
                                    paths are different.)
                                  4 If this parameter is used (bit 3 (MPP) of parameter No. 3703
                                    is set to 1), signals SWS1 to SWS2 <G027 bits 0 to 1>
                                    become invalid.
                                  5 To use this parameter, the multi–spindle control function is
                                    needed.
                                  NOTE
                                  1 This parameter is valid when the multi–spindle control option
                                    is selected.
                                  2 When the constant surface speed control option is selected,
                                    the spindle speed is clamped at the specified maximum speed,
                                    regardless of whether the G96 mode or G97 mode is specified.
                                  3 When this parameter is set to 0, parameter No. 3772
                                    (maximum speed of the first spindle) is valid. The spindle
                                    speed is not clamped when parameter No. 3772 is set to 0.
                                  4 When spindle speed command control is applied using the
                                    PMC, this parameter has no effect, and the spindle speed is
                                    not clamped.
                                              180
B–63090EN/02                                                              4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
                                     NOTE
                                       These parameters are used for the multi–spindle control.
                                             Data for adjusting the gain of the analog output of the third–spindle speed
                              3820
                                     NOTE
                                       This parameter is used for controlling the multi–spindles.
                                     NOTE
                                       This parameter is used for controlling the multi–spindles.
                                                    181
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS                                                                        B–63090EN/02
                                  NOTE
                                  1 This parameter is valid when the multi–spindle control option
                                    is selected.
                                  2 When the constant surface speed control option is selected,
                                    the spindle speed is clamped at the specified maximum
                                    speed, regardless of whether the G96 mode or G97 mode
                                    is set.
                                  3 When 0 is set in this parameter, the setting of parameter
                                    No.3772 for the first spindle is used. When 0 is set in
                                    parameter No.3772, the spindle speed is not clamped.
                                  4 When spindle speed command control is applied using the
                                    PMC, this parameter has no effect, and the speed of the
                                    spindle is not clamped.
                                  NOTE
                                    These parameters are used for the multi–spindle control.
                                              182
B–63090EN/02                                                                4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
    Table 4.22 (a) Parameters for Control of Serial Interface Spindle Cs Contouring Control Axis
  No.     Data type                                              Description
 3900       Byte      First group for the   Number of the servo axis whose loop gain is to be changed according to
                      first spindle         the set values of parameters 3901 to 3904 when the Cs contouring axis is
                                            controlled (set values 0 to 8)
 3901          Word                         Loop gain for the servo axis when the Cs contouring axis is controlled for
                                            spindle gear 1 selection
 3902          Word                         Loop gain for the servo axis when the Cs contouring axis is controlled for
                                            spindle gear 2 selection
 3903          Word                         Loop gain for the servo axis when the Cs contouring axis is controlled for
                                            spindle gear 3 selection
 3904          Word                         Loop gain for the servo axis when the Cs contouring axis is controlled for
                                            spindle gear 4 selection
 3910          Byte   Second group for      Number of the servo axis whose loop gain is to be changed according to
                      the first spindle     the set values of parameters 3911 to 3914 when the Cs contouring axis is
                                            controlled (set values 0 to 8)
 3911          Word                         Loop gain for the servo axis when the Cs contouring axis is controlled for
                                            spindle gear 1 selection
 3912          Word                         Loop gain for the servo axis when the Cs contouring axis is controlled for
                                            spindle gear 2 selection
 3913          Word                         Loop gain for the servo axis when the Cs contouring axis is controlled for
                                            spindle gear 3 selection
 3914          Word                         Loop gain for the servo axis when the Cs contouring axis is controlled for
                                            spindle gear 4 selection
 3920          Byte   Third group for the   Number of the servo axis whose loop gain is to be changed according to
                      first spindle         the set values of parameters 3921 to 3924 when the Cs contouring axis is
                                            controlled (set values 0 to 8)
 3921          Word                         Loop gain for the servo axis when the Cs contouring axis is controlled for
                                            spindle gear 1 selection
 3922          Word                         Loop gain for the servo axis when the Cs contouring axis is controlled for
                                            spindle gear 2 selection
 3923          Word                         Loop gain for the servo axis when the Cs contouring axis is controlled for
                                            spindle gear 3 selection
 3924          Word                         Loop gain for the servo axis when the Cs contouring axis is controlled for
                                            spindle gear 4 selection
                                        <Setting method>
                                        First, select servo axes which perform interpolation with the Cs
                                        contouring axis. (Up to three axes can be selected.)
                                        When there is no servo axis for interpolation with the Cs contouring axis,
                                        set the parameters 3900, 3910 and 3920 to 0 to terminate parameter
                                        setting.
                                        When there are servo axes for interpolation with the Cs contouring axis,
                                        the parameters must be set according to the procedure below for each axis.
                                        (1) Set the number of a servo axis (1 to 4) for interpolation with the Cs
                                            contouring axis in parameters 39n0 (n = 0, 1 and 2).
                                        (2) Set loop gain values of the servo axis specified in (1) above which is
                                            used when the Cs contouring axis is controlled in parameters 39n1,
                                            39n2, 39n3, and 39n4. (There are four stages for main gears used.)
                                        (3) When the number of specified servo axes is less than 3, set the
                                            remaining parameters (39n0) to 0 to terminate parameter setting.
                                            When the number of a Cs contouring axis is set to parameter 39n0,
                                            the parameter is assumed to be set to 0.
                                                        183
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS                                                       B–63090EN/02
                               NOTE
                                The loop gain used for Cs contouring control is selected
                                when the mode changes from the spindle mode to the Cs
                                contouring axis control mode according to the gears set at
                                this time.
                                If gears are switched in the Cs contouring axis control mode,
                                the loop gain cannot be changed.
                                           184
B–63090EN/02                                                                  4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
                                                            185
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS                                                                       B–63090EN/02
 No.    Data type   Parameters to be used if the spindle switch function is not used or to be used for
                    the MAIN spindle when the spindle is switched
                                                                                      (No.4000 to 4135)
 4040     Word      Normal velocity loop proportional gain (HIGH)
 4041     Word      Normal velocity loop proportional gain (LOW)
 4042     Word      Velocity loop proportional gain during orientation (HIGH)
 4043     Word      Velocity loop proportional gain during orientation (LOW)
 4044     Word      Velocity loop proportional gain in servo mode/spindle synchronization (HIGH)
 4045     Word      Velocity loop proportional gain in servo mode/spindle synchronization (LOW)
 4046     Word      Velocity loop proportional gain in Cs contour control (HIGH)
 4047     Word      Velocity loop proportional gain in Cs contour control (LOW)
 4048     Word      Normal velocity loop integral gain (HIGH)
 4049     Word      Normal velocity loop integral gain (LOW)
 4050     Word      Velocity loop integral gain during orientation (HIGH)
 4051     Word      Velocity loop integral gain during orientation (LOW)
 4052     Word      Velocity loop integral gain in servo mode/spindle synchronization (HIGH)
 4053     Word      Velocity loop integral gain in servo mode/spindle synchronization (LOW)
 4054     Word      Velocity loop integral gain in Cs contour control (HIGH)
 4055     Word      Velocity loop integral gain in Cs contour control (LOW)
 4056     Word      Gear ratio (HIGH)
 4057     Word      Gear ratio (MEDIUM HIGH)
 4058     Word      Gear ratio (MEDIUM LOW)
 4059     Word      Gear ratio (LOW)
 4060     Word      Position gain during orientation (HIGH)
 4061     Word      Position gain during orientation (MEDIUM HIGH)
 4062     Word      Position gain during orientation (MEDIUM LOW)
 4063     Word      Position gain during orientation (LOW)
 4064     Word      Position gain change ratio when orientation is completed
 4065     Word      Position gain in servo mode/spindle synchronization (HIGH)
 4066     Word      Position gain in servo mode/spindle synchronization (MEDIUM HIGH)
 4067     Word      Position gain in servo mode/spindle synchronization (MEDIUM LOW)
 4068     Word      Position gain in servo mode/spindle synchronization (LOW)
 4069     Word      Position gain in Cs contour control (HIGH)
 4070     Word      Position gain in Cs contour control (MEDIUM HIGH)
 4071     Word      Position gain in Cs contour control (MEDIUM LOW)
 4072     Word      Position gain in Cs contour control (LOW)
 4073     Word      Grid shift amount in servo mode
 4074     Word      Reference position return speed in Cs contour/servo mode
 4075     Word      Orientation completion signal detection level
 4076     Word      Motor velocity limit value during orientation
 4077     Word      Orientation stop position shift amount
 4078     Word      MS signal constant
 4079     Word      MS signal gain adjustment
                                                       186
B–63090EN/02                                                                4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
  No.     Data type   Parameters to be used if the spindle switch function is not used or to be used for
                      the MAIN spindle when the spindle is switched
                                                                                        (No.4000 to 4135)
 4080          Word   Conventional: Regenerative power limit
                      HRV: Regenerative power limit in high–speed area/Regenerative power limit
 4081          Word   Delay time prior to motor power shut–off
 4082          Word   Acceleration/deceleration time setting
 4083          Word   Motor voltage during normal rotation
 4084          Word   Motor voltage during orientation
 4085          Word   Motor voltage in servo mode/spindle synchronization
 4086          Word   Motor voltage in Cs contour control
 4087          Word   Over–speed level
 4088          Word   Excessive velocity deviation detection level when the motor is constrained
 4089          Word   Excessive velocity deviation detection level when the motor is rotated
 4090          Word   Overload detection level
 4091          Word   Position gain change ratio when returning to the origin in the servo mode
 4092          Word   Position gain change ratio when returning to the origin in Cs contour control
 4093          Word   Load meter displayed value for maximum output (low–speed winding)
 4094          Word   Disturbance torque compensation constant
 4095          Word   Speed meter output voltage adjustment value
 4096          Word   Load meter output voltage adjustment value
 4097          Word   Spindle velocity feedback gain
 4098          Word   Maximum speed at which position coder signal can be detected
 4099          Word   Delay time for energizing the motor
 4100          Word   Conventional:Base velocity of the motor output specification
                      HRV:Base velocity of the motor output specification
 4101          Word   Conventional:Output limit value for the motor output specification
                      HRV:Torque limit value for the motor output specification
 4102          Word   Conventional:Base speed
                      HRV:Excitation voltage saturation speed under no load
 4103          Word   Conventional:Magnetic flux weakening start velocity
                      HRV:Base speed limit ratio
 4104          Word   Conventional:Current loop proportional gain
                      HRV:Current loop proportional gain
 4105          Word   Conventional:Current loop proportional gain (in Cs contour control)
                      HRV:Reserved
 4106          Word   Conventional:Current loop integral gain
                      HRV:Current loop integral gain
 4107          Word   Conventional:Current loop integral gain (in Cs contour control)
                      HRV:Reserved
 4108          Word   Conventional:Current loop integral gain zero speed
                      HRV:Current loop integral gain zero speed
 4109          Word   Conventional:Current loop proportional gain velocity factor
                      HRV:Filter time constant when the specified voltage is saturated
                                                         187
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS                                                                            B–63090EN/02
 No.    Data type   Parameters to be used if the spindle switch function is not used or to be used for
                    the MAIN spindle when the spindle is switched
                                                                                      (No.4000 to 4135)
 4110     Word      Conventional:Current conversion constant
                    HRV:Current conversion constant
 4111     Word      Conventional:Secondary current factor for exciting current
                    HRV:Secondary current factor
 4112     Word      Conventional:Current expectation constant
                    HRV:Level for determining the saturation of specified voltage/PWM command clamp val-
                    ue
 4113     Word      Conventional:Slip constant
                    HRV:Slip constant
 4114     Word      Conventional:High–speed rotation slip compensation constant
                    HRV:Slip compensation factor in high–speed area/Slip compensation factor during decel-
                    eration
 4115     Word      Conventional:Compensation constant of voltage applied to motor in the dead zone
                    HRV:PWM command clamp value during deceleration
 4116     Word      Conventional:Electromotive force compensation constant
                    HRV:Motor leak constant
 4117     Word      Conventional:Electromotive force phase compensation constant
                    HRV:Voltage compensation factor in high–speed area in steady state/Motor voltage fac-
                    tor in steady state
 4118     Word      Conventional:Electromotive force compensation velocity factor
                    HRV:Voltage compensation factor in high–speed area during acceleration/Motor voltage
                    factor during acceleration
 4119     Word      Conventional:Time constant of voltage filter for electromotive force compensation
                    HRV:Time constant for changing the exciting current during deceleration
 4120     Word      Conventional:Dead zone compensation data
                    HRV:Voltage without rectangular wave component/Dead zone compensation data
 4121     Word      Time constant for changing the torque
 4122     Word      Velocity detection filter time constant
 4123     Word      Short–term overload detection time
 4124     Word      Conventional:Voltage compensation factor during deceleration
                    HRV:Reserved
 4125     Word
 4126     Word
 4127     Word      Conventional:Load meter displayed value for maximum output
                    HRV:Load meter displayed value for maximum output
 4128     Word      Conventional:Maximum output limit zero speed
                    HRV:Maximum torque curve compensation factor
 4129     Word      Conventional:Secondary current factor during rigid tapping
                    HRV:Secondary current factor during rigid tapping
 4130     Word      Conventional:Compensation factor for the phase of the electromotive force during decel-
                    eration
                    HRV:Velocity factor for the proportional gain of the current loop/Current phase lag com-
                    pensation constant
                                                       188
B–63090EN/02                                                                  4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
  No.     Data type    Parameters to be used if the spindle switch function is not used or to be used for
                       the MAIN spindle when the spindle is switched
                                                                                         (No.4000 to 4135)
 4131          Word    Time constant of the speed detection filter (in Cs contour control)
 4132          Word    Conversion constant of the phase–V current
 4133          Word    Motor model code
 4134          2Word
 4135          2Word   Grid shift amount in Cs contour control
  No.     Data type    Parameters for low–speed characteristics if the spindle switch function is not used
                       or if the output switch function is used on the MAIN spindle when the spindle is
                       switched
                                                                                         (No.4136 to 4175)
 4136          Word    Motor voltage during normal rotation
 4137          Word    Motor voltage in servo mode/spindle synchronization
 4138          Word    Conventional:Base velocity of the motor output specification
                       HRV:Base velocity of the motor output specification
 4139          Word    Conventional:Output limit value for the motor output specification
                       HRV:Torque limit value for the motor output specification
 4140          Word    Conventional:Base speed
                       HRV:Excitation voltage saturation speed under no load
 4141          Word    Conventional:Magnetic flux weakening start velocity
                       HRV:Base speed limit ratio
 4142          Word    Conventional:Current loop proportional gain
                       HRV:Current loop proportional gain
 4143          Word    Conventional:Current loop integral gain
                       HRV:Current loop integral gain
 4144          Word    Conventional:Current loop integral gain zero speed
                       HRV:Current loop integral gain zero speed
 4145          Word    Conventional:Current loop proportional gain velocity factor
                       HRV:Filter time constant when the specified voltage is saturated
 4146          Word    Conventional:Current conversion constant
                       HRV:Current conversion constant
 4147          Word    Conventional:Secondary current factor for exciting current
                       HRV:Secondary current factor
 4148          Word    Conventional:Current expectation constant
                       HRV:Level for determining the saturation of specified voltage/PWM command clamp val-
                       ue
 4149          Word    Conventional:Slip constant
                       HRV:Slip constant
 4150          Word    Conventional:High–speed rotation slip compensation constant
                       HRV:Slip compensation factor in high–speed area/Slip compensation factor during decel-
                       eration
 4151          Word    Conventional:Compensation constant of voltage applied to motor in the dead zone
                       HRV:PWM command clamp value during deceleration
                                                         189
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS                                                                            B–63090EN/02
 No.    Data type   Parameters for low–speed characteristics if the spindle switch function is not used
                    or if the output switch function is used on the MAIN spindle when the spindle is
                    switched
                                                                                      (No.4136 to 4175)
 4152     Word      Conventional:Electromotive force compensation constant
                    HRV:Motor leak constant
 4153     Word      Conventional:Electromotive force phase compensation constant
                    HRV:Voltage compensation factor in high–speed area in steady state/Motor voltage fac-
                    tor in steady state
 4154     Word      Conventional:Electromotive force compensation velocity factor
                    HRV:Voltage compensation factor in high–speed area during acceleration/Motor voltage
                    factor during acceleration
 4155     Word      Conventional:Voltage compensation factor during deceleration
                    HRV:Reserved
 4156     Word      Temperature compensation gain
 4157     Word      Time constant for changing the torque
 4158     Word      Conventional:Maximum output limit zero speed
                    HRV:Maximum torque curve compensation factor
 4159     Word      Conventional:Secondary current factor during rigid tapping
                    HRV:Secondary current factor during rigid tapping
 4160     Word      Hysteresis of the speed detection level
 4161     Word      Conventional:Compensation factor for the phase of the electromotive force during decel-
                    eration
                    HRV:Velocity factor for the proportional gain of the current loop/Current phase lag com-
                    pensation constant
 4162     Word      Cutting feed velocity loop integral gain in Cs contour control (HIGH)
 4163     Word      Cutting feed velocity loop integral gain in Cs contour control (LOW)
 4164     Word      Conversion constant of the phase–V current
 4165     Word      Conventional:Time constant of voltage filter for electromotive force compensation
                    HRV:Time constant for changing the exciting current during deceleration/Time constant
                    for changing the exciting current
 4166     Word      Conventional:Regenerative power limit
                    HRV:Regenerative power limit in high–speed area/Regenerative power limit
 4167     Word
 4168     Word      Overload current alarm detection level (for low–speed characteristics)
 4169     Word      Overload current alarm detection time constant
 4170     Word      Overload current alarm detection level (for high speed characteristics)
 4171     Word      Number of teeth of spindle gear (HIGH)
 4172     Word      Number of teeth of position detector gear (HIGH)
 4173     Word      Number of teeth of spindle gear (LOW)
 4174     Word      Number of teeth of position detector gear (LOW)
 4175     Word      Analog override zero level
                                                      190
B–63090EN/02                                                                 4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
  No.     Data type   Parameters for SUB spindle if the spindle switch function is provided
                                                                                         (No.4176 to 4283)
 4176           Bit   Bit parameter
 4177           Bit   Bit parameter
 4178           Bit   Bit parameter
 4179           Bit   Bit parameter
 4180           Bit   Bit parameter
 4181           Bit   Bit parameter
 4182           Bit   Bit parameter
 4183           Bit   Bit parameter
 4184           Bit   Bit parameter
 4185           Bit   Bit parameter
 4186           Bit   Bit parameter
 4187           Bit   Bit parameter
 4188           Bit   Bit parameter
 4189           Bit   Bit parameter
 4190           Bit   Bit parameter
 4191           Bit   Bit parameter (Cannot be changed by the user. See Note 1.)
 4192           Bit   Bit parameter
 4193           Bit   Bit parameter
 4194           Bit   Bit parameter
 4195           Bit   Bit parameter (For setting parameters automatically. See Note 2.)
 4196          Word   Maximum motor speed
 4197          Word   Speed arrival detection level
 4198          Word   Speed detection level
 4199          Word   Speed zero detection level
 4200          Word   Torque limit value
 4201          Word   Load detection level 1
 4202          Word   Output limit pattern
 4203          Word   Output limit value
 4204          Word   Position coder method orientation stop position
 4205          Word   Spindle orientation speed
 4206          Word   Normal velocity loop proportional gain (HIGH)
 4207          Word   Normal velocity loop proportional gain (LOW)
 4208          Word   Velocity loop proportional gain during orientation (HIGH)
 4209          Word   Velocity loop proportional gain during orientation (LOW)
 4210          Word   Velocity loop proportional gain in servo mode (HIGH)
 4211          Word   Velocity loop proportional gain in servo mode (LOW)
 4212          Word   Normal velocity loop integral gain
 4213          Word   Velocity loop integral gain during orientation
 4214          Word   Velocity loop integral gain in servo mode
 4215          Word
 4216          Word   Gear ratio (HIGH)
 4217          Word   Gear ratio (LOW)
                                                           191
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS                                                                         B–63090EN/02
 No.    Data type   Parameters for SUB spindle if the spindle switch function is provided
                                                                                       (No.4176 to 4283)
 4218     Word      Position gain during orientation (HIGH)
 4219     Word      Position gain during orientation (LOW)
 4220     Word      Position gain change ratio when orientation is completed
 4221     Word      Position gain in servo mode (HIGH)
 4222     Word      Position gain in servo mode (LOW)
 4223     Word      Grid shift amount in servo mode
 4224     Word
 4225     Word
 4226     Word      Orientation completion signal level
 4227     Word      Motor velocity limit value during orientation
 4228     Word      Orientation stop position shift amount
 4229     Word      MS signal constant
 4230     Word      MS signal gain adjustment
 4231     Word      Regenerative power limit
 4232     Word      Delay time prior to motor power shut–off
 4233     Word      Acceleration/deceleration time setting
 4234     Word      Spindle load monitor observer gain 1 (on the SUB side)
 4235     Word      Spindle load monitor observer gain 2 (on the SUB side)
 4236     Word      Motor voltage during normal rotation
 4237     Word      Motor voltage during orientation
 4238     Word      Motor voltage in servo mode
 4239     Word      Position gain change ratio when returning to the origin in the servo mode
 4240     Word      Feed forward coefficient
 4241     Word      Velocity loop feed forward factor
 4242     Word
 4243     Word      Number of teeth of spindle gear (HIGH)
 4244     Word      Number of teeth of position detector gear (HIGH)
 4245     Word      Number of teeth of spindle gear (LOW)
 4246     Word      Number of teeth of position detector gear (LOW)
 4247     Word      Spindle load monitor magnetic flux compensation time constant (for high–speed charac-
                    teristics on the MAIN side)
 4248     Word      Spindle load monitor torque constant (for high–speed characteristics on the MAIN side)
 4249     Word      Spindle load monitor observer gain 1 (on the MAIN side)
 4250     Word      Spindle load monitor observer gain 2 (on the MAIN side)
 4251     Word      Spindle load monitor magnetic flux compensation time constant (for low–speed charac-
                    teristics on the MAIN side)
 4252     Word      Spindle load monitor magnetic flux compensation time constant (for high–speed charac-
                    teristics on the SUB side)
 4253     Word      Spindle load monitor magnetic flux compensation time constant (for low–speed charac-
                    teristics on the SUB side)
 4254     Word      Temperature compensation gain (for high–speed characteristics on the SUB side)
 4255     Word      Temperature compensation gain (for low–speed characteristics on the SUB side)
 4256     Word      Base velocity of the motor output specification
                                                        192
B–63090EN/02                                                                  4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
  No.     Data type   Parameters for SUB spindle if the spindle switch function is provided
                                                                                         (No.4176 to 4283)
 4257          Word   Output limit value for the motor output specification
 4258          Word   Base speed
 4259          Word   Magnetic flux weakening start velocity
 4260          Word   Current loop proportional gain
 4261          Word   Current loop integral gain
 4262          Word   Current loop integral gain zero speed
 4263          Word   Current loop proportional gain velocity factor
 4264          Word   Current conversion constant
 4265          Word   Secondary current factor for exciting current
 4266          Word   Current expectation constant
 4267          Word   Slip constant
 4268          Word   High–speed rotation slip compensation constant
 4269          Word   Compensation constant of voltage applied to motor in the dead zone
 4270          Word   Electromotive force compensation constant
 4271          Word   Electromotive force phase compensation constant
 4272          Word   Electromotive force compensation velocity factor
 4273          Word   Time constant for changing the torque
 4274          Word   Load meter displayed value for maximum output
 4275          Word   Maximum output limit zero speed
 4276          Word   Secondary current factor during rigid tapping
 4277          Word   Compensation factor for the phase of the electromotive force during deceleration
 4278          Word   Velocity detection filter time constant
 4279          Word   Load meter displayed value at maximum output (low–speed winding)
 4280          Word   Time constant of voltage filter for electromotive force compensation
 4281          Word   Spindle load monitor torque constant (for low–speed characteristics on the MAIN side)
 4282          Word   Spindle load monitor torque constant (for high–speed characteristics on the SUB side)
 4283          Word   Spindle load monitor torque constant (for low–speed characteristics on the SUB side)
                                                         193
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS                                                                           B–63090EN/02
 No.    Data type   Parameters for low–speed characteristics when the output switch function is used
                    on the SUB spindle side if the spindle switch function is provided
                                                                                            (No.4284 to 4351)
 4284     Word      Motor voltage during normal rotation
 4285     Word      Motor voltage in servo mode
 4286     Word      Base velocity of the motor output specification
 4287     Word      Output limit value for the motor output specification
 4288     Word      Base speed
 4289     Word      Magnetic flux weakening start velocity
 4290     Word      Current loop proportional gain
 4291     Word      Current loop integral gain
 4292     Word      Current loop integral gain zero speed
 4293     Word      Current loop proportional gain velocity factor
 4294     Word      Current conversion constant
 4295     Word      Secondary current factor for exciting current
 4296     Word      Current expectation constant
 4297     Word      Slip constant
 4298     Word      High–speed rotation slip compensation constant
 4299     Word      Compensation constant of voltage applied to motor in the dead zone
 4300     Word      Electromotive force compensation constant
 4301     Word      Electromotive force phase compensation constant
 4302     Word      Electromotive force compensation velocity factor
 4303     Word      Time constant for changing the torque
 4304     Word      Maximum output limit zero speed
 4305     Word      Secondary current factor during rigid tapping
 4306     Word      Compensation factor for the phase of the electromotive force during deceleration
 4307     Word      Regenerative power limit
 4308     Word      Time constant of voltage filter for electromotive force compensation
 4309     Word      Motor model code
 4310    2Word
 4311    2Word
 4312     Word      Position coder method orientation end signal detection level 2 (MAIN)
 4313     Word      Magnetic sensor method orientation end signal detection level 1 (MAIN)
 4314     Word      Magnetic sensor method orientation end signal detection level 2 (MAIN)
 4315     Word      Magnetic sensor method orientation stop position shift amount (MAIN)
 4316     Word      Position coder method orientation end signal detection level 2 (SUB)
 4317     Word      Magnetic sensor method orientation end signal detection level 1 (SUB)
 4318     Word      Magnetic sensor method orientation end signal detection level 2 (SUB)
 4319     Word      Magnetic sensor method orientation stop position shift amount (SUB)
 4320     Word      Motor deceleration time constant (MAIN/HIGH)
 4321     Word      Motor deceleration time constant (MAIN/MEDIUM HIGH)
 4322     Word      Motor deceleration time constant (MAIN/MEDIUM LOW)
 4323     Word      Motor deceleration time constant (MAIN/LOW)
 4324     Word      Motor deceleration time constant (SUB/HIGH)
                                                       194
B–63090EN/02                                                                4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
  No.     Data type   Parameters for low–speed characteristics when the output switch function is used
                      on the SUB spindle side if the spindle switch function is provided
                                                                                                (No.4284 to 4351)
 4325          Word   Motor deceleration time constant (SUB/LOW)
 4326          Word   Deceleration time constant limit start speed (MAIN/HIGH)
 4327          Word   Deceleration time constant limit start speed (SUB/HIGH)
 4328          Word   Position coder–based spindle orientation command multiplication (MAIN)
 4329          Word   Position coder–based spindle orientation command multiplication (SUB)
 4330          Word   Deceleration time constant limit start speed (MAIN/LOW)
 4331          Word   Deceleration time constant limit start speed (SUB/LOW)
 4332          Word
 4333          Word
 4334          Word   Number of arbitrary pulses of speed detector (MAIN)
 4335          Word   Number of arbitrary pulses of speed detector (SUB)
 4336          Word   Change point for spindle synchronous acceleration/deceleration time constant
 4337          Word   Velocity compensation factor for velocity loop gain (MAIN)
 4338          Word   Velocity compensation factor for velocity loop gain (SUB)
 4339          Word   Torque clamp level
 4340          Word   Bell–shaped acceleration/deceleration time constant for spindle synchronization
 4341          Word   Abnormal load detection level
 4342          Word
 4343          Word
 4344          Word   Look–ahead feed forward coefficient
 4345          Word   Spindle motor speed command detection level
 4346          Word   Incomplete integral coefficient
 4347          Word   Detection level for spindle 1–to–2 speed difference at slave operation
 4348          Word   Overload current alarm detection level (for low–speed characteristics)
 4349          Word   Overload current alarm detection time constant
 4350          Word   Overload current alarm detection level (for high–speed characteristics)
 4351          Word   Compensation for current detection offset
  No.     Data type   Parameters for the MAIN spindle when the spindle is switched and the like
                                                                                      (No.4352 to 4372)
 4352           Bit   Bit parameter
 4353           Bit   Bit parameter
 4354          Word
 4355          Word   MZ sensor signal amplitude ratio compensation
 4356          Word   MZ sensor signal phase difference compensation
 4357          Word   BZ sensor signal amplitude ratio compensation
 4358          Word   BZ sensor signal phase difference compensation
 4359          Word
 4360          Word
 4361          Word   Number of arbitrary pulses of position detector
 4362          Word
                                                        195
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS                                                                  B–63090EN/02
 No.    Data type   Parameters for the MAIN spindle when the spindle is switched and the like
                                                                                    (No.4352 to 4372)
 4363     Word
 4364     Word
 4365     Word
 4366     Word
 4367     Word
 4368     Word
 4369     Word
 4370     Word
 4371     Word
 4372     Word      Safe rotation speed
 No.    Data type   Parameters for the SUB spindle when the spindle is switched and the like
                                                                                    (No.4373 to 4393)
 4373      Bit      Bit parameter
 4374      Bit      Bit parameter
 4375     Word      Shift amount in synchronous control of the spindle phase
 4376     Word
 4377     Word
 4378     Word
 4379     Word
 4380     Word
 4381     Word
 4382     Word
 4383     Word
 4384     Word      EGB automatic phasing maximum speed
 4385     Word      EGB automatic phasing acceleration/deceleration time constant
 4386     Word      Number of sinusoidal waves of position detector of the master spindle
 4387     Word      Numerator of EGB synchronization ratio
 4388     Word      Denominator of EGB synchronization ratio
 4389     Word
 4390     Word
 4391     Word      Center frequency of vibration suppression filter
 4392     Word      Frequency width of vibration suppression filter
 4393     Word
                                                      196
B–63090EN/02                                                             4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
  NOTE
  1 Among the parameters of the spindle amplifier with the serial interface, parameters Nos. 4015
    and 4191 cannot be changed by the users.
    These parameters require to assign optional software to the CNC and are automatically set
    depending on the type of the software.
  2 To set the parameters of the spindle amplifier with the serial interface automatically, set #7 of
    parameter No.4019 (if the sub spindle is set in the CNC with the spindle switching function, use
    parameter No.4195) to 1, assign the model code of the motor to be used to parameter No.4133
    (if the sub spindle is set in the CNC with the spindle switching function, use parameter No.4309),
    turn off the power of the CNC and spindle amplifier, and restart the CNC and spindle amplifier.
  3 Parameters No.4000 to No.4539 are used in the processing on the spindle amplifier. See
    FANUC AC SPINDLE MOTOR α series PARAMETER MANUAL (B–65150E).
  4 The CNC can control up to two spindle amplifiers with the serial interface.
    Up to three spindle amplifiers can be controlled in the Series 16 performing single–path control.
    When the spindle control amplifier provides the spindle switching function, one spindle amplifier
    can control two spindle motors using the switching function.
    The output switching function can be used in spindle motors to be connected.
    Up to four spindles, or eight types, can be used by switching the spindle motors. (The number
    of spindles that can controlled simultaneously is the same as the number of spindle amplifiers,
    that is two spindles.)
    Parameters of the spindle amplifier with the serial interface correspond to the above functions
    as follows:
     (1) Parameter No.4000 to No.4539 “S1”: First spindle amplifier
          Parameter No.4000 to No.4539 “S2”: Second spindle amplifier
     (2) Parameter No.4000 to No.4175 “S1”/“S2”: When the spindle switching function is not
          provided, or for the main spindle in the spindle amplifier when the function is provided.
          Parameter No.4176 to No.4351 “S1”/“S2”: For the sub spindle in the spindle amplifier when
          the spindle switching function is provided.
     (3) Parameters at low speed when the output switching function is provided.
          Parameters No.4136 to No.4175 “S1”/“S2”: When the spindle switching function is not
          provided, or for the main spindle when the function is provided.
          Parameters No.4284 to No.4351 “S1”/“S2”: For the sub spindle when the spindle switching
          function is provided.
  5 The CNC stores the parameters of the spindle amplifier with the serial interface. The CNC sends
    them to the spindle amplifier at the system power on and they are used in the unit.
    These parameters are sent from the CNC to the spindle amplifier in a batch when:
      – The CNC is switched on.
      – The serial spindle is restarted by a reset that is carried out after spindle communication
          alarm 749 occurs (because the spindle control unit is switched off or because of noise).
    If these parameters are rewritten, they are sent from the CNC to the spindle amplifier
    sequentially when:
      – The parameters have been entered from the MDI.
      – The parameters have been entered as programmable (G10).
      – The parameters have been entered via the reader/punch interface.
     To set parameters automatically, upload parameters corresponding to the motor model from
     the spindle amplifier to the CNC prior to the procedure specified above.
     The parameters of the spindle amplifier with serial interface can be changed after the
     system starts. Changing the parameters (No.4000 to No.4539 “S1”, “S2”) in the CNC sends
     them to the spindle amplifier at an appropriate time and the parameters in the unit are
     updated. Be careful not to change parameters incorrectly.
                                                      197
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS                                                                              B–63090EN/02
                                        #7        #6         #5         #4         #3         #2         #1        #0
                           4800        SPK       EPZ                                                    ND2        ND1
                                   NOTE
                                    When this parameter is set, the power must be turned off
                                    before operation is continued.
                                        Error pulse between two spindles when synchronizing phases in the serial
                            4810
                                        spindle synchronization control mode
                                        Allowable error count for the error pulses between two spindles in the serial
                            4811
                                        spindle synchronization control mode or simple synchronous control mode
                                                 198
B–63090EN/02                                                               4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
                                  Set the allowable error count for the error pulses between two spindles in
                                  the serial spindle synchronization control mode or simple synchronous
                                  control mode.
                                      NOTE
                                       This parameter is used to output the inter–spindle phase
                                       error detection signal SYCAL in the serial spindle
                                       synchronization control mode. The SYCAL <F044#4>
                                       signal becomes “1” when a phase error exceeding the value
                                       set in this parameter is found.
                                       When you are going to use this parameter to detect error
                                       pulses during simplified synchronization control, pay
                                       attention to the mode of the spindle, and set the parameter
                                       as required. (The parameter is invalid in spindle mode. It is
                                       valid in Cs contour control, rigid tapping, and spindle
                                       positioning mode; the detection unit per pulse differs,
                                       however.)
4821 Master axis of first spindle under simple synchronous spindle control
4822 Master axis of second spindle under simple synchronous spindle control
                                      NOTE
                                        When this parameter has been set, the power must be
                                        turned off before oparation is continued.
                                      NOTE
                                      1 This parameter is valid if bit 5 (SSY) of parameter No. 3704
                                        is set to 1.
                                      2 After this parameter is set, the power must be turned off then
                                        back on for the setting to become effective.
                                                    199
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS                                                                           B–63090EN/02
                               Set a permissible error of error pulse between two spindles in the mode of
                               simple synchronous spindle control. The data unit is the unit of the
                               detector used meanwhile.
                                   NOTE
                                   1 This parameter is valid if bit 5 (SSY) of parameter No. 3704
                                     is set to 1.
                                   2 This parameter is used to output the signals of synchronous
                                     error detection under synchronous spindle control SYCAL1
                                     to SYCAL2 <F043 bits 0 to 1>.
                                   3 Under simple synchronous spindle control in the spindle
                                     mode, no synchronization error is detected.
                                   NOTE
                                     When this parameter has been set, the power must be
                                     turned off before operation is continued.
                                   NOTE
                                   1 This parameter is valid if bit 4 (SSS) of parameter No. 3704
                                     is set to 1.
                                   2 After this parameter is set, the power must be turned off then
                                     back on for the setting to become effective.
                                        #7       #6        #5         #4        #3         #2         #1       #0
                                                                                                               FLR
                           4900
                                               200
B–63090EN/02                                                               4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
                                           Rapid (q) of the fluction of spindle speed which is assumed to be the speci-
                               4911        fied spindle speed
                                      NOTE
                                       Unit of data depends on parameter No.4900#0 FLR.
                                  Set the ratio (q) of the spindle speed which is assumed to be the specified
                                  spindle speed in the spindle speed fluctuation detection function.
                                  Let the commanded speed be Sc. When the actual spindle speed reaches
                                  between (Sc–Sq) and (Sc + Sq), it is assumed to be the commanded speed.
                                  The spindle speed fluctuation detection starts.
                                                          q
                                  where, Sq = Sc
                                                         100
                                           Spindle speed fluctuation ratio (r) for which no alarm is activated in the
                               4912        spindle speed fluctuation detection function
                                      NOTE
                                       Unit of data depends on parameter No.4900#0 FLR.
                                  Set the spindle speed fluctuation ratio (r) for which no alarm is activated in
                                  the spindle speed fluctuation detection function (see Fig.4.22 (e)).
                                           Spindle speed fluctuation value (d) for which no alarm is activated in the
                               4913        spindle speed fluctuation detection function
                                                    201
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS                                                                        B–63090EN/02
Spindle speed
                                                                                                  Sm
                                                  Sd                                                   Specified
                                                  Sd                                                   speed
                                                                                                  Sm
Actual speed
                                     Check        No                 Check
                                                  check
                                                                                                             Time
                                        Command         Check                        Alarm
                                        another         start
                                        speed
                                       Time (p) elapsed from when the commanded spindle speed is changed to the
                           4914        start of spindle speed fluctuation detection
                                                                                                 Sm
                                                  Sd                                                   Specified
                                                  Sd                                                   speed
                                                                                                 Sm
                                                                                                 Actual speed
                                                   P
                                                  No                Check
                                                  check
                                                                                                             Time
                                        Command         Check                        Alarm
                                        another         start
                                        speed
                                                  202
B–63090EN/02                                              4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
                                    #7    #6       #5      #4      #3        #2    #1       #0
                                   IMB    ESI     TRV                       ISZ   IDM      IOR
                       4950
                              NOTE
                               The extended specification includes the following two
                               extensions:
                                (1) With the conventional specification, the number of M
                                    codes for specifying a spindle positioning angle is
                                    always 6. With the extended specification, an arbitrary
                                    number of such M codes from 1 to 256 can be selected
                                    by parameter setting (See parameter No.4964.)
                                (2) The maximum feedrate for spindle positioning (setting of
                                    parameter No.1420) can be extended from 240000 to
                                    269000 (in increments of 10 deg/min).
                                          203
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS                                                                              B–63090EN/02
                                    NOTE
                                     In the case of half–fixed angle positioning based on M codes,
                                     three types of spindle positioning operations can occur:
                                      (1) The spindle rotation mode is cleared, then the mode is
                                          switched to the spindle positioning mode.
                                      (2) Spindle positioning is performed in the spindle
                                          positioning mode.
                                      (3) The spindle positioning mode is cleared, then the mode
                                          is switched to the spindle rotation mode.
                                     In the case of specifiection A:
                                     Operations (1) to (3) are specified using separate M codes.
                                      (1) Specified using M codes for performing spindle
                                          orientation.
                                          (See parameter No.4960)
                                      (2) Specified using M codes for specifying a spindle
                                          positioning angle. (See parameter No.4962)
                                      (3) Specified using M codes for clearing spindle positioning
                                          operation. (See parameter No.4961.)
                                     In the case of specification B:
                                     When M codes for specifying a spindle positioning angle are
                                     specified, operations (1) to (3) are performed successively.
                                     (See parameter No.4962.)
                                                204
B–63090EN/02                                                              4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
                                      NOTE
                                       q represents the basic angular displacement set in
                                       pamrameter No.4963.
                                                     205
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS                                                                               B–63090EN/02
                                  NOTE
                                  1 This parameter is valid when bit 6 (ESI) of parameter
                                    No.4950=1.
                                  2 Make sure that M codes from Mα to M (α+β–1) do not
                                    duplicate other M codes.
                                  3 Setting this parameter to 0 has the same effect as setting 6.
                                    That is, M code from Mα to M (α+5) are used for half–fixed
                                    angle positioning.
                                  NOTE
                                   The above parameters No.4970 to No.4974 are for analog
                                   spindles.
                                              206
B–63090EN/02                                                4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
4.23
PARAMETERS OF                      #7      #6       #5      #4       #3      #2      #1       #0
TOOL
                       5001
COMPENSATION                              EVO      TPH     EVR      TAL     OFH      TLB     TLC
                                          207
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS                                                          B–63090EN/02
                                      #7     #6      #5      #4      #3      #2      #1       #0
                                     WNP    LWM     LGC     LGT             LWT     LGN       LD1
                          5002
                                 NOTE
                                  When the option of tool geometry/wear compensation is
                                  equipped and LGT = 0, the offset is done in a T code block
                                  regardless of this parameter.
                      WNP Imaginary tool tip direction used for tool nose radius compensation, when
                          the geometry/wear compensation option is equipped, is the direction
                          specified by:
                          0 : Geometry offset number
                          1 : Wear offset number
                                            208
B–63090EN/02                                              4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
                                   #7      #6     #5      #4      #3       #2      #1      #0
                                  TGC     LVC                             CCN
                       5003
                                          LVK                             CCN     SUV     SUP
                              NOTE
                                When this parameter is set, the power must be turned off
                                before operation is continued.
                                         209
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS                                                            B–63090EN/02
                                      #7     #6       #5       #4      #3      #2       #1     #0
                                             TLE      QNI                     PRC              CNI
                          5005
                                 NOTE
                                   If this parameter setting is changed, reset the tool offset
                                   data.
                                             210
B–63090EN/02                                                4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
                       NOTE
                         In the MDI mode, cutter compensation C (M series) or
                         tool–nose radius compensation (T series) is not performed,
                         irrespective of the setting of this parameter.
[FS16 format]
                                                C           B
                                                        Start point
                                                D           A
                                            End point
Center
                                      211
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS                                                                          B–63090EN/02
                           [FS15 format]
                                                     B
                                                                 Start point
                                                                     A
                                                            End point
Center
                                 NOTE
                                   The setting of this parameter determines the travel distance
                                   determination method for circular interpolation not during
                                   cutter compensation C (M series) or tool–nose radius
                                   compensation (T series) as well. Accordingly, if this
                                   parameter is set, the setting of bit 3 (CQD) of parameter No.
                                   3450 is invalid.
                       GCS If G49 (G code for canceling tool length compensation) and G40 (G code
                           for canceling cutter compensation) are specified in a single block, the tool
                           length compensation is cancelled:
                           0 : In the next block.
                           1 : In the specified block.
                                      #7      #6         #5         #4         #3         #2         #1        #0
                                                                                                              GSG
                          5009
                                 NOTE
                                   When this parameter has been set, the power must be
                                   turned off before operation is continued.
                                             212
B–63090EN/02                                                                4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
                                         Limit value that ignores the vector when a tool moves on the outside of a corner during
                                         tool nose radius compensation
                              5010
                                         Limit value that ignores the vector when a tool moves on the outside of a corner
                                         during cutter compensation C
Programmed path
                                                     213
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS                                                                           B–63090EN/02
                                 Set the maximum allowable value for the tool wear compensation value,
                                 input as an incremental value. If the incremental input value (absolute value)
                                 exceeds the set value, the following alarm or warning message is output:
                                    Input from MDI        Warning: Setting value out of range.
                                    Input using G10       P/S alarm No.032: Offset value is out of range by
                                                          G10.
                                                 214
B–63090EN/02                                                                    4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
                                                                                                                 mesurement
                                                                                                                 reference
                                Xm                                                                               position
                                                 X–axis –contact face
Xp
                              Z–axis +contact
                              face                                          Z–axis –contact face
+X Zm
                                                                               Zp
                       +Z
Fig.4.23 Distance along X and Z Axes from the Reference Position to +/– Contact Surfaces
                                                     Tool offset number used for the input of tool offset value measured B
                                     5020
                                                #7         #6        #5         #4          #3        #2        #1            #0
                                                                                                                             OWD
                                     5040
                                            NOTE
                                              When this parameter has been set, the power must be
                                              turned off before operation is continued.
                                                         215
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS                                                             B–63090EN/02
4.24
PARAMETERS OF
CANNED CYCLES
4.24.1
Parameter of canned                      #7      #6      #5      #4     #3       #2      #1      #0
                                                 M5T                    ILV     RTR             FXY
Cycle for Drilling         5101
                                         M5B     M5T     RD2    RD1                     EXC     FXY
                                  NOTE
                                   In the case of the T series, this parameter is valid only for the
                                   drilling canned cycle in the Series 15 format.
                       EXC G81
                           0 : Specifies a drilling canned cycle
                           1 : Specifies an external operation command
                       RTR G83 and G87
                           0 : Specify a high–speed peck drilling cycle
                           1 : Specify a peck drilling cycle
                        ILV Initial point position in drilling canned cycle
                            0 : Not updated by reset
                            1 : Updated by reset
                  RD2, RD1 Set the axis and direction in which the tool in drilling canned cycle G76 or
                           G87 is got free. RD2 and RD1 are set as shown below by plane selection.
                                   RD2         RD1     G17     G18    G19
                                    0           0      +X      +Z     +Y
                                    0           1      –X      –Z     –Y
                                    1           0      +Y      +X     +Z
                                    1           1      –Y      –X     –Z
                       M5T When a spindle rotates from the forward to the reverse direction and vice
                           versa in tapping cycles G84 and G74 for M series (G84 and G88 for T
                           series), befor M04 or M03 is output:
                           For T series
                           0 : Not output M05
                           1 : Outputs M05
                               For M series
                               0 : Outputs M05
                               1 : Not output M05
                       M5B In drilling canned cycles G76 and G87:
                           0 : Outputs M05 before an oriented spindle stops
                           1 : Not output M05 before an oriented spindle stops
                                                 216
B–63090EN/02                                               4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
                                   #7      #6     #5       #4      #3       #2      #1      #0
                                   RDI    RAB     K0E     RFC      F16     QSR     MRC
                       5102
                              NOTE
                               This parameter is valid for multiple repetitive turning canned
                               cycle type I.
                    QSR Before a multiple repetitive canned cycle (G70 to G73) is started, a check
                        to see if the program contains a block that has the sequence number
                        specified in address Q is:
                        0 : Not made.
                        1 : Made. (If the sequence number specified in address Q cannot be
                            found, an alarm occurs and the canned cycle is not executed.)
                     F16 When the Series 10/11 format is used (with bit 1 (FCV) of parameter
                         No.0001 set to 1), a canned drilling cycle is specified using :
                         0 : Series 10/11 format
                         1 : Series 21 format. (However, the number of repetitions is specified
                             using address L.)
                    RFC For the semifinish figure of G71 or G72 and for a cutting pattern of G73,
                        tool–nose radius compensation is:
                        0 : Not performed.
                        1 : Performed.
                    K0E When K0 is specified in a hole machining canned cycle (G80 to G89):
                        0 : Hole machining is performed once.
                        1 : Hole machining is not performed. Instead, the hole machining data is
                            merely memorized.
                    RAB The R command for the drilling canned cycle in the Series 10/11 format is:
                        0 : Regarded as an incremental command
                        1 : Regarded as:
                            An absolute command in the case of G code system A
                            An absolute command in the case of G code system B or C when the
                            G90 mode is specified.
                            An incremental command in the case of G code system B or C when
                            the G91 mode is specified.
                     RDI The R command for the drilling canned cycle in the Series 10/11 format:
                         0 : Is regarded as the specification of a radius
                         1 : Follows the specification of a diameter/radius for the drilling axis
                                          217
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS                                                                     B–63090EN/02
                                       #7        #6       #5       #4        #3       #2        #1       #0
                                                TCZ                                   P15      TFD
                          5103
                                                TCZ                                            QZA       SIJ
                                       #7       #6        #5       #4        #3       #2        #1       #0
                                                                                     FCK       BCR
                          5104
                                               218
B–63090EN/02                                                             4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
                                      NOTE
                                      1 The machining profile is checked before the operation of the
                                        canned cycle (not during machining).
                                      2 The machining profile to be checked is a programmed
                                        profile. The path of retraction or return is not checked.
                                      3 This parameter is not valid for G71 or G72 of the canned
                                        cycle for grinder.
                                      NOTE
                                        M03 is output when “0” is set.
                                                  219
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS                                                                                B–63090EN/02
                                  NOTE
                                    M04 is output when “0” is set.
                                                                             q : Depth of cut
                                                                             d : Return value
                                                                                                 R point
                                                               q
                                                                                      d
                                                               q
                                                                                           d
Z point
                                 For T series this parameter sets the return or clearance value in drilling
                                 canned cycle G83.
                                                             R point                                               R point
                           q                                                      q
                                                 d                                                             d
                           q                                                      q
                                                       d                                                       d
q q
Z point Z point
                                                     220
B–63090EN/02                                                               4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
                               5115
                                                                    Clearance of canned cycle G83
                                                                              q : Depth of cut
                                                                              d : Clearance value
                                                                                                R point
                                                                q
                                                                                           d
                                                                q
                                                                                           d
Z point
                                                    221
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS                                                                           B–63090EN/02
4.24.2
Parameter of Thread          5130
                                                Chamfering distance in the thread cutting cycles G76 and G92
Cutting Cycle
                   [Data type] Byte
                 [Unit of data] 0.1 pitch
             [Valid data range] 0 to 127
                                  This parameter sets the chamfering in the thread cutting cycles G76 and
                                  G92.
4.24.3
Parameter of Multiple 5132                      Depth of cut in multiple repetitive canned cycles G71 and G72
Repetitive Canned
Cycle            [Data type] 2–word
                 [Unit of data]
                                    Increment system           IS-B                 IS-C                     Unit
                                      Millimeter input         0.001                0.001                    mm
                                        Inch input             0.0001               0.0001                   inch
                                                 222
B–63090EN/02                                                              4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
                                                   223
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS                                                                                  B–63090EN/02
4.24.4
                                         #7           #6         #5         #4         #3         #2         #1             #0
Parameters of Peck
Drilling Cycle of a         5160
                                                                                                 NOL         OLS
Small Diameter
                   [Data type] Bit
                         OLS When an overload torque signal is received in a peck drilling cycle of a
                             small diameter, the feed and spindle speed are
                             0 : Not changed.
                             1 : Changed.
                        NOL When the depth of cut per action is satisfied although no overload torque
                            signal is received in a peck drilling cycle of a small diameter, the feed and
                            spindle speed are:
                            0 : Not changed.
                            1 : Changed.
                                                    224
B–63090EN/02                                                             4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
                               5163
                                             M code that specifies the peck drilling cycle mode of a small diameter
                               5164     Percentage of the spindle speed to be changed when the tool is retracted after
                                        an overload torque signal is received
                               5165     Percentage of the spindle speed to be changed when the tool is retracted with-
                                        out an overload torque signal received
                               5166     Percentage of cutting feedrate to be changed when the tool is retracted after an
                                        overload torque signal is received
                                                  225
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS                                                                                 B–63090EN/02
                            5167       Percentage of the cutting feedrate to be changed when the tool is retracted
                                       without an overload torque signal received
                            5168       Lower limit of the percentage of the cutting feedrate in a peck drilling cycle of a
                                       small diameter
                            5170       Number of the macro variable to which the total number of retractions during
                                       cutting is output
                                   NOTE
                                    The total number cannot be output to common variables 500
                                    to 531.
                                                  226
B–63090EN/02                                                                4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
                               5171         Number of the macro variable to which the total umber of retractions because of
                                            an overload signal is output
                                      NOTE
                                       The total number cannot be output to common variables 500
                                       to 531.
                               5172
                                                       Speed of retraction to point R when no address I is issued
                               5173         Speed of advancing to the position just before the bottom of a hole when no
                                            address I is issued
                               5174
                                                         Clearance in a peck drilling cycle of a small diameter
                                                      227
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS                                                            B–63090EN/02
4.25
PARAMETERS OF
                                      #7      #6      #5       #4     #3       #2       #1     #0
RIGID TAPPING                        SRS     FHD              DOV     SIG     CRG      VGR     G84
                          5200
                                             FHD      PCP     DOV     SIG     CRG      VGR     G84
                                 NOTE
                                  For serial spindles, set this parameter to 0 when using the
                                  DMR function for position coder signals on the spindle side.
                       CRG Rigid mode when a rigid mode cancel command is specified (G80, G01
                           group G code, reset, etc.)
                           0 : Canceled after rigid tapping signal RGTAP is set to “0”.
                           1 : Canceled before rigid tapping signal RGTAP is set to “0”.
                        SIG When gears are changed for rigid tapping, the use of SIND <G032 and
                            G033> is
                            0 : Not permitted.
                            1 : Permitted.
                       DOV Override during extraction in rigid tapping
                           0 : Invalidated
                           1 : Validated (The override value is set in parameter No.5211.)
                       PCP Rigid tapping
                           0 : Used as a high–speed peck tapping cycle
                           1 : Not used as a high–speed peck tapping cycle
                       FHD Feed hold and single block in rigid tapping
                           0 : Invalidated
                           1 : Validated
                        SRS To select a spindle used for rigid tapping in multi–spindle control:
                            0 : The spindle selection signals SWS1 and SWS2 (bits 0 and 1 of G027)
                                are used. (These signals are used also for multi–spindle control.)
                            1 : The rigid tapping spindle selection signals RGTSP1 and RGTSP2
                                (bits 4 and 5 of G061) are used. (These signals are provided expressly
                                for rigid tapping.)
                                             228
B–63090EN/02                                               4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
                                   #7      #6      #5       #4      #3      #2       #1      #0
                                                           OV3     OVU     TDR
                       5201
                                                           OV3     OVU     TDR               NIZ
                       5202
                                                                                            ORI
                              NOTE
                               When this parameter is set, the power must be turned off
                               before operation is continued.
                              NOTE
                                This parameter can be used only for a serial spindle.
                                   #7     #6       #5      #4       #3     #2       #1       #0
                                                          OVS      RGS     RFF
                       5203
                                                          OVS              RFF
                                         229
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS                                                                B–63090EN/02
                       RGS When bit 0 (MIF) of parameter No. 1403 is set to 1 and rigid tapping is
                           specified in feed–per–minute mode, the spindle speed becomes:
                           0 : 1/1000 of the specified speed.
                           1 : 1/1 of the specified speed.
                       OVS In rigid tapping, override by the feedrate override signal and invalidation
                           of override by the override cancel signal is:
                           0 : Disabled.
                           1 : Enabled.
                               Setting this parameter enables override by the feedrate override signal
                               <G012> to be applied for rigid tapping operation (cutting and extraction)
                               in rigid tapping.
                               The spindle speed override is fixed to 100%, but override is also applied to
                               the spindle speed in synchronization with the feedrate along the tapping
                               axis by feedrate override.
                               The override cancel signal OVC <bit 4 of G006> also become available.
                                 NOTE
                                 1 When this parameter is set to override the feedrate, override
                                   by parameters (see parameters Nos. 5211 (T/M) and 5381
                                   (M)) is disabled.
                                 2 Regardless of whether this parameter is set, when feedrate
                                   override is disabled by the override cancel signal OVC <bit
                                   4 of G006>, override by parameters (see parameters Nos.
                                   5211 (T/M) and 5381 (M)) is enabled.
                                      #7       #6       #5       #4       #3       #2       #1       #0
                                                                                           SPR      DGN
                          5204
                                                                                                    DGN
                                 NOTE
                                  When this parameter is set, the power must be turned off
                                  before operation is continued.
                                              230
B–63090EN/02                                                          4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
                                      NOTE
                                      1 When switching between the rigid tapping parameters on a
                                        spindle–by–spindle basis in rigid tapping using the second
                                        serial spindle, set this parameter to 1. The following
                                        parameters are supported for each spindle:
                                              First spindle       Second spindle
                                             (4–stage gear)        (2–stage gear)
                                           No.5214               No.5215
                                           No.5221 to No.5224    No.5225, No.5226
                                           No.5231 to No.5234    No.5235, No.5236
                                           No.5241 to No.5244    No.5245, No.5246
                                           No.5261 to No.5264    No.5265, No.5266
                                           No.5271 to No.5274    No.5335, No.5336
                                           No.5280               No.5341
                                           No.5281 to No.5284    No.5242, No.5243
                                           No.5300, No.5301      No.5302, No.5303
                                           No.5310 to No.5314    No.5350 to No.5353
                                           No.5321 to No.5324    No.5325, No.5326
                                      2 For rigid tapping using the second serial spindle, the
                                        multispindle control option is required.
                                           #7       #6      #5         #4        #3        #2       #1    #0
                                                                                                         RCK
                               5205
                                                                                          NRV            RCK
                                      NOTE
                                       When you want to perform rigid tapping, do not set this
                                       parameter.
                                       If rigid tapping is performed with this parameter set, a
                                       tapping tool, workpiece, or machine may be damaged.
                                                  231
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS                                                                             B–63090EN/02
                                   NOTE
                                   1 The M code is judged to be 29 (M29) when “0” is set.
                                   2 To use an M code whose number is greater than 255, Specify
                                     the code number with parameter No.5212.
                                   NOTE
                                    The override value is valid when DOV in parameter No.5200
                                    #4 is “1”.
                                      When OVU (bit 3 of parameter No.5201) is 1, the unit of set data
                                      is 10%. An override of up to 200% can be applied to extraction.
                                   NOTE
                                    If the setting of this parameter is 0, the M code specifying the
                                    rigid tapping mode is determined by the setting of parameter
                                    5210. Otherwise, it is determined by the setting of parameter
                                    5212. The setting of parameter 5212 must always be within
                                    the above valid range.
                            5213
                                                         Return or clearance in peck tapping cycle
                                                 232
B–63090EN/02                                                                4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
                                                                R point                                                R point
                              q                                                    q
                                                    d                                                           d
                              q                                                    q
                                                          d                                                     d
q q
Z point Z point
                                           Setting of an allowable rigid tapping synchronization error range for the second
                               5215
                                           spindle
                                      NOTE
                                       When rigid tapping is performed using the second spindle
                                        • When the SPR parameter (bit 1 of parameter No.5204) is
                                          set to 0, the setting of parameter No.5214 is applied to the
                                          second spindle, as well as to the first spindle.
                                        • When the SPR parameter (bit 1 of parameter No.5204) is
                                          set to 1, the setting of parameter No.5215 is applied to the
                                          second spindle, respectively.
                                                        233
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS                                                                           B–63090EN/02
                                  NOTE
                                  1 These parameters are enabled when the VGR parameter
                                    (bit 1 of parameter No.5200) is set to 1.
                                  2 When a position coder is attached to the spindle, set the
                                    same value for all of parameters No.5221 through No.5224.
                                  3 When the DMR function of the position coder signal is used
                                    with a serial spindle, set the VGR parameter (bit 1 of
                                    parameter No.5200) to 0, and set these parameters to 0.
                                  4 When rigid tapping is performed using the second and third
                                    spindles
                                    • When the SPR parameter (bit 1 of parameter No.5204)
                                        is set to 0, the settings of parameters No.5221 and
                                        No.5222 are applied to the second and third spindles, as
                                        well as to the first spindle.
                                    • When the SPR parameter (bit 1 of parameter No.5204)
                                        is set to 1, the settings of parameters No.5225 and
                                        No.5226 are applied to the second spindle, while the
                                        settings of parameters No.5227 and No.5228 are applied
                                        to the third spindle.
                                              234
B–63090EN/02                                                              4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
                                           Number of position coder gear teeth for the second spindle (first–stage gear)
                              5235
                                         Number of position coder gear teeth for the second spindle (second–stage gear)
                              5236
                                     NOTE
                                     1 These parameters are enabled when the VGR parameter
                                       (bit 1 of parameter No.5200) is set to 1.
                                       When a position coder is attached to the spindle, set the
                                       same value for all of parameters No.5231 through No.5234.
                                       When a spindle motor with a built–in position coder is used,
                                       a position coder with a resolution of 2048 pulses/rev may be
                                       used. In such a case, set the actual number of teeth,
                                       multiplied by 2 (for conversion to 4096 pulses/rev).
                                     2 When the DMR function of the position coder signal is used
                                       with a serial spindle, set the VGR parameter (bit 1 of
                                       parameter No.5200) to 0, and set these parameters to 0.
                                     3 When rigid tapping is performed using the second and third
                                       spindles
                                       • When the SPR parameter (bit 1 of parameter No.5204)
                                           is set to 0, the settings of parameters No.5231 and
                                           No.5232 are applied to the second and third spindles, as
                                           well as to the first spindle.
                                       • When the SPR parameter (bit 1 of parameter No.5204)
                                           is set to 1, the settings of parameters No.5235 and
                                           No.5236 are applied to the second spindle, while the
                                           settings of parameters No.5237 and No.5238 are applied
                                           to the third spindle.
                                                   235
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS                                                                             B–63090EN/02
                                      Maximum spindle speed in rigid tapping using the second spindle (first–stage gear)
                            5245
                                      Maximum spindle speed in rigid tapping using the second spindle (second–stage gear)
                            5246
                                   NOTE
                                   1 For the M series, set the same value for both parameter
                                     No.5241 and parameter No.5243 for a one–stage gear
                                     system. For a two–stage gear system, set the same value
                                     for parameter No.5242 and parameter No.5243. Otherwise,
                                     P/S alarm No.200 will be issued.
                                   2 When rigid tapping is performed using the second and third
                                     spindles
                                     • When the SPR parameter (bit 1 of parameter No.5204)
                                         is set to 0, the settings of parameters No.5241 and
                                         No.5242 are applied to the second and third spindles, as
                                         well as to the first spindle.
                                     • When the SPR parameter (bit 1 of parameter No.5204)
                                         is set to 1, the settings of parameters No.5245 and
                                         No.5246 are applied to the second spindle, while the
                                         settings of parameters No.5247 and No.5248 are applied
                                         to the third spindle.
                                                 236
B–63090EN/02                                                              4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
                                         Linear acceleration/deceleration time constant for the spindle and tapping axis
                              5261
                                         (first–stage gear)
                                         Linear acceleration/deceleration time constant for the spindle and tapping axis
                              5262
                                         (second–stage gear)
                                         Linear acceleration/deceleration time constant for the spindle and tapping axis
                              5263
                                         (third–stage gear)
                                         Linear acceleration/deceleration time constant for the spindle and tapping axis
                              5264       (fourth–stage gear)
                                         Linear acceleration/deceleration time constant for the second spindle and tap-
                              5265       ping axis (first–stage gear)
                                         Linear acceleration/deceleration time constant for the second spindle and tap-
                              5266       ping axis (second–stage gear)
                                     NOTE
                                       When rigid tapping is performed using the second and third
                                       spindles
                                       • When the SPR parameter (bit 1 of parameter No.5204)
                                          is set to 0, the settings of parameters No.5261 and
                                          No.5262 are applied to the second and third spindles, as
                                          well as to the first spindle.
                                       • When the SPR parameter (bit 1 of parameter No.5204)
                                          is set to 1, the settings of parameters No.5265 and
                                          No.5266 are applied to the second spindle, while the
                                          settings of parameters No.5267 and No.5268 are applied
                                          to the third spindle.
                                                   237
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS                                                                                 B–63090EN/02
5271 Time constant for the spindle and tapping axis in extraction operation (first–stage gear)
                                      Time constant for the spindle and tapping axis in extraction operation
                           5272
                                      (second–stage gear)
5273 Time constant for the spindle and tapping axis in extraction operation (third–stage gear)
                                      Time constant for the spindle and tapping axis in extraction operation
                           5274       (fourth–stage gear)
                                  NOTE
                                  1 These parameters are enabled when the TDR parameter (bit
                                    2 of parameter No.5201) is set to 1.
                                  2 When rigid tapping is performed using the second and third
                                    spindles
                                    • When the SPR parameter (bit 1 of parameter No.5204)
                                       is set to 0, the settings of parameters No.5271 and
                                       No.5272 are applied to the second and third spindles, as
                                       well as to the first spindle.
                                    • When the SPR parameter (bit 1 of parameter No.5204)
                                       is set to 1, the settings of parameters No.5335 and
                                       No.5336 are applied to the second spindle, while the
                                       settings of parameters No.5337 and No.5338 are applied
                                       to the third spindle.
                                                 238
B–63090EN/02                                                                 4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
                                           Position control loop gain for the spindle and tapping axis in rigid tapping
                                5280
                                           (common to all gears)
                                           Position control loop gain for the spindle and tapping axis in rigid tapping
                                5281
                                           (first–stage gear)
                                           Position control loop gain for the spindle and tapping axis in rigid tapping
                                5282
                                           (second–stage gear)
                                           Position control loop gain for the spindle and tapping axis in rigid tapping
                                5283
                                           (third–stage gear)
                                           Position control loop gain for the spindle and tapping axis in rigid tapping
                                5284       (fourth–stage gear)
                                       NOTE
                                         Once these parameters have been set, the power must be
                                         turned off then back on for the settings to become effective.
                                       NOTE
                                       1 To use a varied loop gain on a gear–by–gear basis, set
                                         parameter No.5280 to 0, and set a loop gain for each gear
                                         in parameters No.5281 through No.5284. The specification
                                         of a loop gain on a gear–by–gear basis is disabled if
                                         parameter No.5280 is set to a value other than 0. In such
                                         a case, the value set in parameter No.5280 is used as a loop
                                         gain that is common to all the gears.
                                       2 When rigid tapping is performed using the second and third
                                         spindles
                                         • When the SPR parameter (bit 1 of parameter No.5204)
                                            is set to 0, the setting of parameter No.5280 or the
                                            settings of parameters No.5281 and No.5282 are applied
                                            to the second and third spindles, as well as to the first
                                            spindle.
                                         • When the SPR parameter (bit 1 of parameter No.5204)
                                            is set to 1, the settings of parameters No.5341 through
                                            No.5343 are applied to the second spindle, while the
                                            settings of parameters No.5344 through No.5346 are
                                            applied to the third spindle.
                                                     239
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS                                                                                    B–63090EN/02
5291 Spindle loop gain multiplier in the rigid tapping mode (for gear 1)
5292 Spindle loop gain multiplier in the rigid tapping mode (for gear 2)
5293 Spindle loop gain multiplier in the rigid tapping mode (for gear 3)
                                                    Spindle loop gain multioplier in the rigid tapping mode (for gear4)
                                5294
                                        NOTE
                                          These parameters are used for analog spindles.
                                             When the spindle motor, spindle, and position coder are connected
                                             as shown left, let the variables be as follows:
       Spindle
       Motor                                 E = 1.667 (V) (A motor speed of 6000 rpm corresponds to 10 V.)
                            Position         L = 360_        (One rotation of the spindle corresponds to one rotation
                 Spindle    coder                     of the spindle motor.)
                                             α = La/4096
                              P.C              = 720_/4096
                                               = 0.17578
                                             La = 720_           (= 360_  2. One rotation of the position coder
                                                      corresponds to two rotations of the spindle.)
                                             4096 =          The number of detected pulses per rotation of the
                                                      position coder
                                             Gear ratio between the spindle and the position coder
                                               1:1 . . . . . . . 0.08789 degrees
                           1:1:2               1:2 . . . . . . . 0.17578 degrees
                                               1:4 . . . . . . . 0.35156 degrees
                                               1:8 . . . . . . . 0.70313 degrees
                                             According to above ratio the loop gain multiplier is calculated as
                                             2048  1.667/360  0.17578  1000 = 1667
                                                * When the position coder which is built in a spindle motor sends
                                                 512 pulses per rotation, the unit used for the detection, α, is
                                                 La/2048.
Fig.4.25 (b) Connection among the spindle motor, spindle, and position coder
                                                      240
B–63090EN/02                                                              4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
                                     NOTE
                                     1 If an excessively large value is specified, the threading
                                       precision will deteriorate.
                                     2 When rigid tapping is performed using the second and third
                                       spindles
                                       • When the SPR parameter (bit 1 of parameter No.5204)
                                          is set to 0, the settings of parameter No.5300 and
                                          No.5301 are applied to the second and third spindles, as
                                          well as to the first spindle.
                                       • When the SPR parameter (bit 1 of parameter No.5204)
                                          is set to 1, the settings of parameters No.5302 and
                                          No.5303 are applied to the second spindle, while the
                                          settings of parameters No.5304 and No.5305 are
                                          applied to the third spindle.
                                             Tapping axis in–position width in rigid tapping using the second spindle
                              5302
                                     NOTE
                                       These parameters are enabled when the SPR parameter
                                       (bit 1 of parameter No.5204) is set to 1.
                                                   241
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS                                                                             B–63090EN/02
5310 Positional deviation limit imposed during tapping axis movement in rigid tapping
                                  NOTE
                                  1 When a high–resolution detector is used, the unit must be
                                    multiplied by 10.
                                  2 When rigid tapping is performed using the second and third
                                    spindles
                                    • When the SPR parameter (bit 1 of parameter No.5204)
                                       is set to 0, the setting of parameter No.5310 (or No.5314)
                                       is applied to the second and third spindles, as well as to
                                       the first spindle.
                                    • When the SPR parameter (bit 1 of parameter No.5204)
                                       is set to 1, the settings of parameters No.5350 and
                                       No.5354 are applied to the second spindle and third
                                       spindle, respectively.
5311 Limit value of spindle positioning deviation during movement in rigid tapping.
                                                242
B–63090EN/02                                                                       4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
(Calculation example)
                                                  S= 3600
        Spindle
                                                  G  = 3000
        Motor
                                                  L= 360 degrees (One spindle rotation per spindle motor rotation)
                              Position            α= La/4096
                  Spindle     coder                 =720 degrees/4096
                                P.C                 =0.17578 degrees
                                                  La = 720 degrees
                                                     (One position coder rotation requires two spindle rotations
                                                     (= 360 degrees  2)).
                                                  4096 = Detection pulse per position coder rotation
                                                                     3600  360  100  1.5
                                                  Setting value =
                                                                      60  3000  0.17578
                                                               = 6144
                            1:1:2
Fig.4.25 (c) Connection among spindle motor, spindle and position coder
                                             NOTE
                                             1 The detection unit is α = La/2048 when the position coder
                                               built–in spindle motor uses a position coder of 512 pulses
                                               per revolution.
                                             2 When rigid tapping is performed using the second and third
                                               spindles
                                               • When the SPR parameter (bit 1 of parameter No.5204)
                                                  is set to 0, the setting of parameter No.5311 is applied to
                                                  the second and third spindles, as well as to the first
                                                  spindle.
                                               • When the SPR parameter (bit 1 of parameter No.5204)
                                                  is set to 1, the settings of parameters No.5351 and
                                                  No.5355 are applied to the second spindle and third
                                                  spindle, respectively.
5312 Positional deviation limit imposed while the tapping axis is stopped in rigid tapping
                                             NOTE
                                               When rigid tapping is performed using the second and third
                                               spindles
                                               • When the SPR parameter (bit 1 of parameter No.5204)
                                                  is set to 0, the setting of parameter No.5312 is applied to
                                                  the second and third spindles, as well as to the first
                                                  spindle.
                                               • When the SPR parameter (bit 1 of parameter No.5204)
                                                  is set to 1, the settings of parameters No.5352 and
                                                  No.5356 are applied to the second spindle and third
                                                  spindle, respectively.
                                                            243
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS                                                                               B–63090EN/02
5313 Positional deviation limit imposed while the spindle is stopped in rigid tapping
                                  NOTE
                                    When rigid tapping is performed using the second and third
                                    spindles
                                    • When the SPR parameter (bit 1 of parameter No.5204)
                                       is set to 0, the setting of parameter No.5313 is applied to
                                       the second and third spindles, as well as to the first
                                       spindle.
                                    • When the SPR parameter (bit 1 of parameter No.5204)
                                       is set to 1, the settings of parameters No.5353 and
                                       No.5357 are applied to the second spindle and third
                                       spindle, respectively.
5314 Positional deviation limit imposed during tapping axis movement in rigid tapping
                                  NOTE
                                  1 When parameter No.5314 is set to 0, the setting of
                                    parameter No.5310 is used. When parameter No.5314 is
                                    set to a value other than 0, parameter No.5310 is disabled;
                                    in this case, the setting of parameter No.5314 is used.
                                  2 When rigid tapping is performed using the second and third
                                    spindles
                                    • When the SPR parameter (bit 1 of parameter No.5204)
                                        is set to 0, the setting of parameter No.5314 (or No.5310)
                                        is applied to the second and third spindles, as well as to
                                        the first spindle.
                                    • When the SPR parameter (bit 1 of parameter No.5204)
                                        is set to 1, the settings of parameters No.5350 and
                                        No.5354 are applied to the second spindle and third
                                        spindle, respectively.
                                                244
B–63090EN/02                                                                 4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
                                             Spindle backlash in rigid tapping using the second spindle (first–stage gear)
                               5325
                                                      Spindle backlash in rigid tapping using the second spindle
                                          Spindle backlash in rigid tapping using the second spindle (second–stage gear)
                               5326
                                      NOTE
                                        When rigid tapping is performed using the second and third
                                        spindles
                                        • When the SPR parameter (bit 1 of parameter No.5204)
                                           is set to 1, the settings of parameters No.5325 and
                                           No.5326 are applied to the second spindle, while the
                                           settings of parameters No.5227 and No.5228 are
                                           applied to the third spindle.
                                        • When the SPR parameter (bit 1 of parameter No.5204)
                                           is set to 0, the settings of parameters No.5321 and
                                           No.5322 are applied to the second spindle and third
                                           spindle, as well as to the first spindle.
                                                     245
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS                                                                               B–63090EN/02
                                      Time constant for the spindle and tapping axis in second spindle extraction
                           5335       operation (first–stage gear)
                                      Time constant for the spindle and tapping axis in second spindle extraction
                           5336       operation (second–stage gear)
                                  NOTE
                                    This parameter is enabled when both the TDR parameter
                                    (bit 2 of parameter No.5201) and the SPR parameter (bit 1
                                    of parameter No.5204) are set to 1.
                                      Position control loop gain for the spindle and tapping axis in rigid tapping using
                           5341       the second spindle (common to all the gears)
                                      Position control loop gain for the spindle and tapping axis in rigid tapping using
                           5342       the second spindle (first–stage gear)
                                      Position control loop gain for the spindle and tapping axis in rigid tapping using
                           5343       the second spindle (second–stage gear)
                                  NOTE
                                    After these parameters have been set, the power must be
                                    turned off then back on for the settings to become effective.
                                  NOTE
                                  1 To use a varied loop gain on a gear–by–gear basis, set
                                    parameter No.5341 to 0, and set a loop gain for each gear
                                    in parameters No.5342 and No.5343.
                                  2 This parameter is enabled when the SPR parameter (bit 1
                                    of parameter No.5204) is set to 1.
                                                246
B–63090EN/02                                                                 4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
                                           Positional deviation limit imposed during tapping axis movement in rigid tapping
                                5350       using the second spindle
                                       NOTE
                                         This parameter is enabled when the SPR parameter (bit 1
                                         of parameter No.5204) is set to 1.
                                           Positional deviation limit imposed during spindle movement in rigid tapping using
                                5351       the second spindle
                                       NOTE
                                         This parameter is enabled when the SPR parameter (bit 1
                                         of parameter No.5204) is set to 1.
                                           Positional deviation limit imposed while the tapping axis is stopped in rigid tap-
                                5352       ping using the second spindle
                                       NOTE
                                         This parameter is enabled when the SPR parameter (bit 1
                                         of parameter No.5204) is set to 1.
                                                     247
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS                                                                                B–63090EN/02
                                       Positional deviation limit imposed while the spindle is stopped in rigid tapping
                            5353       using the second spindle
                                   NOTE
                                     This parameter is enabled when the SPR parameter (bit 1
                                     of parameter No.5204) is set to 1.
                            5381
                                                             Override value for rigid tapping return
                                   NOTE
                                     This parameter is valid when bit 4 (DOV) of parameter No.
                                     5200 is set to 1. If bit 3 (OVU) of parameter No. 5201 is set
                                     to 1, 10% is set as the units of data. Thus, an override of
                                     up to 2000% can be applied during extraction.
                            5382
                                                            Amount of return for rigid tapping return
                                                 248
B–63090EN/02                                                            4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
4.26
PARAMETERS OF
SCALING/                                 #7         #6        #5         #4        #3         #2         #1       #0
COORDINATE                    5400
                                        SCR        XSC                 RCW                                        RIN
ROTATION
                     [Data type] Bit
                           RIN Coordinate rotation angle command (R)
                               0 : Specified by an absolute method
                               1 : Specified by G90 or G91
                          RCW When a workpiece or local coordinate system command is issued in
                              coordinate system rotation mode:
                              0 : No alarm is issued.
                              1 : An alarm (P/S alarm No. 5302) is issued.
                           XSC Axis scaling and programmable mirror image
                               0 : Invalidated (The scaling magnification is specified by P.)
                               1 : Validated
                           SCR Scaling magnification unit
                               0 : 0.00001 times (1/100,000)
                               1 : 0.001 times
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0
                              5401
                                                                                                                  SCLx
                              5410        Angular displacement used when no angular displacement is specified for coor-
                                          dinate system rotation
                              5411
                                                 Magnification used when scaling magnification is not specified
                                                  249
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS                                                                  B–63090EN/02
                                  NOTE
                                   Parameter No.5421 becomes valid when scaling for every
                                   axis is valid. (XSC, #6 of parameter No.5400 is “1”.)
                           5421
                                                       Scaling magnification for every axis
                                             250
B–63090EN/02                                                                   4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
4.27
PARAMETERS OF
                                             #7         #6          #5          #4         #3          #2         #1          #0
UNI–DIRECTIONAL               5431                                                                                PDI        MDL
POSITIONING
                     [Data type] Bit
                          MDL Specifies whether the G code for single direction positioning (G60) is
                              included in one–shot G codes (00 group) or modal G codes (01 group)
                              0: One–shot G codes (00 group)
                              1: Modal G codes (01 group)
                            PDI When the tool is stopped before or after a specified end point with the
                                unidirectional positioning function:
                                0 : No in–position check is performed.
                                1 : An in–position check is performed.
                                                                               Overrun
                                                                               distance
                                                    Start
                                                    point                                                        Start
                                                                                                                 point
                                                                    End point         Stop after overrun
                              5440
                                            Positioning direction and overrun distance in uni–directional positioning for each axis
                                        –                                                                                        +
                                             Positioning direction (plus)
                                                       251
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS                                                                                 B–63090EN/02
4.28
PARAMETERS OF
NORMAL DIRECTION
CONTROL
                           5480
                                                     Number of the axis for controlling the normal direction
                           5481
                                                        Rotation feedrate of normal direction control axis
                           5482
                                          Limit value that ignores the rotation insertion of normal direction control axis
                                  NOTE
                                  1 No rotation block is inserted when 360 or more degrees are
                                    set.
                                  2 If 180 or more degrees are set, a rotation block is inserted
                                    only when the circular interpolation is 180 or more degrees.
                           5483         Limit value of movement that is executed at the normal direction angle of a pre-
                                        ceding block
                                                  252
B–63090EN/02                                                                 4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
                               N2
       Tool center path                                             For straight line
                                                                    Block N2 is machined with the tool being normal
                                                      N3            to block N1 when the movement of N2 in the
                N1                                                  figure on the left does not exceed the set value.
                             Movement
                                            Programmed path
                     N1
                                                                       For arc
                                    N2 Tool center path                Arc N2 is machined with the tool being normal
                                                                       to block N1 when the arc diameter of N2 in the
                                            N3                         figure on the left does not exceed the setting
                                                                       value. A normal direction axis is not controlled
                                                                       to move in the normal direction according to
                                                                       the arc movement.
Programmed path
Diameter
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0
                                    5484
                                                                                                          CTI
                                                           253
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS                                                                    B–63090EN/02
                                                              (5)                              Tool
                                      (2)
                                            (4)
                                                                           Programmed path
Workpiece
(6)
                               NOTE
                                When this parameter is set to 1, no interference check is
                                made in cutter compensation C.
                                            254
B–63090EN/02                                                         4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
4.29
PARAMETERS OF                             #7       #6       #5        #4       #3        #2         #1    #0
INDEXING INDEX                 5500
TABLE                                     IDX     SIM                G90       INC      ABS         REL   DDP
                                5511
                                                        Negative–directionrotation command M code
                                                 255
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS                                                                       B–63090EN/02
                                 1 to 255:
                                     Sets an M code that sets the index table rotation to the negative
                                     direction. The rotation is set to the negative direction only when an M
                                     code set here is specified in the same block as an index table indexing
                                     command. If the M code is not specified in the same block, the
                                     rotation is always set to the positive direction.
                                  NOTE
                                    Set ABS, #2 of parameter No.5500, to 1.
                           5512
                                                           Unit of index table indexing angle
                                  NOTE
                                   If zero is specified as the setting value, any command can
                                   be specified irrespective of the unit of angle.
                                                256
B–63090EN/02                                                  4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
4.30
PARAMETERS OF
                                     #7       #6        #5     #4      #3        #2       #1      #0
CUSTOM MACROS                       SBV                SBM    HGO                        MGO      G67
                       6000
                                    SBV                SBM    HGO     V15                MGO      G67
                           The tables below indicate the system variables for tool offset numbers 1 to
                           999. The values for tool offset numbers 1 to 200 can be read from or
                           assigned to the system variables in parentheses.
                                            257
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS                                                                  B–63090EN/02
                                 NOTE
                                  This bit is invalid when bit 0 (NOP) of parameter No. 6000 is
                                  set to 1.
                                              258
B–63090EN/02                                               4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
                                   #7      #6      #5      #4       #3     #2       #1      #0
                       6003       MUS     MCY     MSB     MPR      TSE     MIN     MSK
                              NOTE
                               When this parameter is set, the power must be turned off
                               before operation is continued.
                                   #7      #6      #5      #4      #3       #2      #1     #0
                                                                           VHD     MFZ     NAT
                       6004
                                                                                   MFZ     NAT
                                         259
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS                                                              B–63090EN/02
                                 NOTE
                                  When this parameter has been set, the power must be
                                  turned off before operation is continued.
                                      #7       #6      #5       #4      #3       #2      #1      #0
                          6010        *7       *6      *5       *4      *3       *2      *1      *0
6011 =7 =6 =5 =4 =3 =2 =1 =0
6012 #7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0
6013 [7 [6 [5 [4 [3 [2 [1 [0
6014 ]7 ]6 ]5 ]4 ]3 ]2 ]1 ]0
                                             260
B–63090EN/02                                                           4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
                                      NOTE
                                       The M code is judged to be M198 when zero is specified as
                                       the setting value.
                                      NOTE
                                       These parameters can be used when MPR, #4 of parameter
                                       No.6003, is 1. M96 is used as a valid M code and M97 is
                                       used as an invalid M code when MPR is 0, irrespective of the
                                       state of this parameter.
6050 G code that calls the custom macro of program number 9010
6051 G code that calls the custom macro of program number 9011
6052 G code that calls the custom macro of program number 9012
6053 G code that calls the custom macro of program number 9013
6054 G code that calls the custom macro of program number 9014
6055 G code that calls the custom macro of program number 9015
6056 G code that calls the custom macro of program number 9016
6057 G code that calls the custom macro of program number 9017
6058 G code that calls the custom macro of program number 9018
6059 G code that calls the custom macro of program number 9019
                                      NOTE
                                       Setting value 0 is invalid. No custom macro can be called by
                                       G00.
                                                 261
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS                                                                      B–63090EN/02
                                  NOTE
                                   Setting value 0 is invalid. No subprogram can be called by
                                   M00.
6080 M code that calls the custom macro of program number 9020
6081 M code that calls the custom macro of program number 9021
6082 M code that calls the custom macro of program number 9022
6083 M code that calls the custom macro of program number 9023
6084 M code that calls the custom macro of program number 9024
6085 M code that calls the custom macro of program number 9025
6086 M code that calls the custom macro of program number 9026
6087 M code that calls the custom macro of program number 9027
6088 M code that calls the custom macro of program number 9028
6089 M code that calls the custom macro of program number 9029
                                  NOTE
                                   Setting value 0 is invalid. No custom macro can be called by
                                   M00.
                                               262
B–63090EN/02                                                         4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
6090 ASCII code that calls the subprogram of program number 9004
6091 ASCII code that calls the subprogram of program number 9005
                                     NOTE
                                      When this parameter is set, the power must be turned off
                                      before operation is continued.
                                     NOTE
                                       Set 0 when no subprogram is called
                                                263
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS                                                                               B–63090EN/02
4.31
PARAMETERS OF
                            6095                      Number of programs used for simple macro calls
SIMPLE MACROS
                  [Data type] Byte
                [Unit of data] Number of programs
            [Valid data range] 0 to 16
                               This parameter specifies the number of programs used for simple macro
                               calls. When 3 is set, for example, three programs can be called. In this
                               case, the three signals, MCST1, MCST2, and MCST3, among MCST1
                               through MCST16 are enabled as the macro call activation signals for
                               calling the programs. If this parameter is set to 0, this function is disabled.
6096 Number of the first program of programs used for simple macro calls
                                                264
B–63090EN/02                                                          4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
4.32
PARAMETERS OF                  6101               First variable number displayed on pattern data screen 1
PATTERN DATA                   6102               First variable number displayed on pattern data screen 2
INPUT
                               6103               First variable number displayed on pattern data screen 3
                                                265
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS                                                                                      B–63090EN/02
4.33
                                             #7         #6        #5         #4         #3         #2         #1         #0
PARAMETERS OF
                             6131
POSITIONING                                                                                                  EOA        OAD
BY OPTIMUM
ACCELERATION                         NOTE
                                      When this parameter is set, the power must be turned off
                                      before operation is continued.
                              6136
                                           Distance D1 to the first stage of positioning by optimum acceleration for each axis
                              6137
                                           Distance D2 to the second stage of positioning by optimum acceleration for each axis
                              6138
                                           Distance D3 to the third stage of positioning by optimum acceleration for each axis
                                                      266
B–63090EN/02                                                               4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
                              6141
                                                                Distance D1 for level 1 (metric input)
                              6142
                                                                Distance D2 for level 2 (metric input)
                              6143
                                                                Distance D3 for level 3 (metric input)
                              6144
                                                                Distance D4 for level 4 (metric input)
                              6145
                                                                Distance D5 for level 5 (metric input)
                              6146
                                                                Distance D6 for level 6 (metric input)
                              6151
                                                            Distance D1 to the first stage (for inch input)
                              6152
                                                           Distance D2 to the second stage (for inch input)
                              6153
                                                            Distance D3 to the third stage (for inch input)
                              6154
                                                           Distance D4 to the fourth stage (for inch input)
                              6155
                                                            Distance D5 to the fifth stage (for inch input)
                              6156
                                                            Distance D6 to the sixth stage (for inch input)
                                                     267
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS                                                                          B–63090EN/02
                             6161
                                                               First–stage rapid traverse rate
                             6162
                                                             Second–stage rapid traverse rate
                             6163
                                                               Third–stage rapid traverse rate
                             6164
                                                              Fourth–stage rapid traverse rate
                             6165
                                                               Fifth–stage rapid traverse rate
                             6166
                                                               Sixth–stage rapid traverse rate
                             6167
                                                             Seventh–stage rapid traverse rate
                             6171
                                                          First–stage rapid traverse time constant
                             6172
                                                         Second–stage rapid traverse time constant
                             6173
                                                          Third–stage rapid traverse time constant
                             6174
                                                         Fourth–stage rapid traverse time constant
                             6175
                                                          Fifth–stage rapid traverse time constant
                             6176
                                                          Sixth–stage rapid traverse time constant
                             6177
                                                         Seventh–stage rapid traverse time constant
                                                  268
B–63090EN/02                                                         4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
                               6181
                                                        First–stage rapid traverse servo loop gain
                               6182
                                                      Second–stage rapid traverse servo loop gain
                               6183
                                                       Third–stage rapid traverse servo loop gain
                               6184
                                                       Fourth–stage rapid traverse servo loop gain
                               6185
                                                        Fifth–stage rapid traverse servo loop gain
                               6186
                                                       Sixth–stage rapid traverse servo loop gain
                               6187
                                                      Seventh–stage rapid traverse servo loop gain
                                                269
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS                                                                            B–63090EN/02
                                               270
B–63090EN/02                                               4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
4.34
PARAMETERS OF
                                  #7       #6     #5        #4     #3       #2      #1       #0
SKIP FUNCTION                     SKF     SRE     SLS      HSS     MIT              SK0     GSK
                       6200
                                  SKF     SRE              HSS                      SK0
                                   #7     #6       #5       #4      #3      #2       #1      #0
                                  SPE                      IGX     TSA     TSE      SEB     SEA
                       6201
                                  SPE             CSE      IGX     TSA     TSE      SEB     SEA
                                         271
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS                                                          B–63090EN/02
                               NOTE
                                There are two types of compensation: Types A and B. With
                                the skip function, the current position is stored in the CNC
                                according to the skip signal. However, the current position
                                stored in the CNC contains servo delay. The machine position
                                is therefore deviated by the servo delay. The deviation can be
                                obtained from the position deviation of the servo and the error
                                generated due to feedrate acceleration/deceleration
                                performed by the CNC. If the deviation can be compensated,
                                it is not necessary to include the servo delay in measurement
                                errors. The deviation can be compensated with the following
                                two types by the parameter as follows:
                                 (1) Type A:     The deviation is the value calculated from
                                                 the cutting time constant and servo time
                                                 constant (loop gain).
                                 (2) Type B:     The deviation is the error due to
                                                 acceleration/deceleration and the position
                                                 deviation when the skip signal goes on.
                      TSE When the torque limit skip function (G31 P99/98) is used, the skip
                          position held in a system variable is:
                          0 : Position that is offset considering the delay (positional deviation)
                              incurred by the servo system.
                          1 : Position that does not reflect the delay incurred by the servo system.
                               NOTE
                                The torque limit skip function stores the current position in the
                                CNC when the torque limit arrival signal is turned on. However,
                                the current position in the CNC includes a servo system delay,
                                so that the position is shifted from the machine position by an
                                amount corresponding to the servo system delay. The value
                                of this shift can be determined from the servo system positional
                                deviation. When TSE is set to 0, a skip position is determined
                                by subtracting the positional deviation from the current
                                position. When TSE is set to 1, the current position (including
                                the servo system delay) is used as the skip position, without
                                considering any shift or position deviation.
                      TSA When the torque limit skip function (G31 P99/98) is used, torque limit
                          arrival monitoring is performed for:
                          0 : All axes.
                          1 : Only those axes that are specified in the block containing the G31
                              command.
                       IGX When the high-speed skip function is used, SKIP (bit 7 of X004), SKIPP
                           (bit 6 of G006), and +MIT1 to –MIT2 (bits 2 to 5 of X004) are:
                           0 : Enabled as skip signals.
                           1 : Disabled as skip signals.
                                           272
B–63090EN/02                                                         4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
                                       NOTE
                                       1 SKIPP (bit 6 of G006) and +MIT1 to –MIT2 (bits 2 to 5 of X004)
                                         are enabled only when bit 0 (GSK) of parameter No.6200 is set
                                         to 1 and bit 3 (MIT) of parameter No.6200 is set to 1. Note also
                                         that these signals are enabled only for the T series.
                                       2 The skip signals for the multistage skip function (SKIP,
                                         SKIP2 to SKIP8) can also be disabled.
                             CSE For continuos high–speed skip command G31 P90, high–speed skip
                                 signals are :
                                 0 : Effective at either a rising or falling edge (depending on the setting of
                                     bit 6 (SRE) of parameter 6200)
                                 1 : Effective for both the rising and falling edges
                             SPE For the skip function (G31), the skip signal (bit 7 of X004) is:
                                 0 : Disabled.
                                 1 : Enabled.
                                             #7      #6      #5      #4       #3       #2      #1       #0
                                            1S8     1S7     1S6      1S5     1S4      1S3      1S2     1S1
                                6202
                                                                                                       1S1
                                                   273
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS                                                                        B–63090EN/02
                                  Input                 G31
                                  signal
                                      HDI0              1S1
                                  NOTE
                                    HDI0 is high-speed skip signals.
                                       #7        #6          #5      #4       #3        #2       #1        #0
                           6210                                                                 ROS
                                                274
B–63090EN/02                                4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
               NOTE
                 When this parameter is set to perform torque limit skip
                 operation for a Cs counter controlled axis, note the following:
               1 If the load detection state (LDT1 = 1) is set when the torque
                 limit command is specified (TLMH1 = 1) in the Cs mode, no
                 excessive error check at stop is performed for the axis.
               2 If the load detection state (LDT1 = 1) is set in the Cs mode,
                 no in–position check is made for the axis.
                           275
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS                                                                           B–63090EN/02
4.35
PARAMETERS OF
AUTOMATIC TOOL
COMPENSATION
(T SERIES) AND
AUTOMATIC TOOL
LENGTH
COMPENSATION                            #7        #6         #5         #4       #3          #2        #1        #0
                           6240                                                                                  AE0
(M SERIES)
                  [Data type] Bit
                        AE0 Measurement position arrival is assumed when the automatic tool
                            compensation signals XAE and ZAE (bits 0 and 1 of X004) (T system) or
                            the automatic tool length measurement signals XAE, YAE, and ZAE (bits
                            0, 1, and 2 of X004) (M system) are:
                            0: 1
                            1: 0
                                  NOTE
                                   Set a radius value irrespective of whether the diameter
                                   programming or the radius programming is specified.
                                                 276
B–63090EN/02                                                            4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
                                     NOTE
                                      Set a radius value irrespective of whether the diameter
                                      programming or the radius programming is specified.
                                                   277
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS                                                            B–63090EN/02
4.36
PARAMETERS OF
EXTERNAL DATA                         #7      #6       #5      #4      #3      #2       #1      #0
INPUT/OUTPUT              6300       EEX                      ESR     ESC
                                             278
B–63090EN/02                                                               4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
4.37
                                            #7        #6         #5        #4         #3        #2         #1        #0
PARAMETERS OF                                                                        HM8       HM5        HFW       HRP
                               6400
RETRACING BY THE
MANUAL HANDLE
                     [Data type] Bit
                           HRP With the retrace function by the manual handle, the rapid traverse rate is
                               clamped, assuming that:
                               0 : An override of 10% is used.
                               1 : An override of 100% is used.
                          HFW With the retrace function by manual handle, program execution can be
                              performed:
                              0 : In both forward and backward directions.
                              1 : Only in the forward direction.
                    HM8, HM5
                                      HM8          HM5            M code group setting
                                       0             0        Standard (20 groups of four)
                                       0             1        16 groups of five
                                       1             0        10 groups of eight
                                  These parameters set the number of M code groups and the number of M
                                  codes in each group.
                                  (See explanations of parameters Nos. 6411 to 6490.)
                                  When 16 groups of five are used, the meanings of parameters are changed
                                  as follows:
                                  Group A     No.6411(1) to No.6415(5)
                                  Group B     No.6416(1) to No.6420(5)
                                       :
                                  Group P     No.6486(1) to No.6490(5)
                                  When 10 groups of eight are used, they are changed as follows:
                                  Group A    No.6411(1) to No.6418(8)
                                  Group B    No.6419(1) to No.6426(8)
                                      :
                                  Group J    No.6483(1) to No.6490(8)
                                           Travel distance per pulse generated from the manual pulse generator for the
                               6410        retrace function by the manual handle
                                                     279
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS                                                                    B–63090EN/02
                                M code (1) in group A for backward movement by the retrace function by the
                         6411   manual handle
                                M code (2) in group A for backward movement by the retrace function by the
                         6412   manual handle
                                M code (3) in group A for backward movement by the retrace function by the
                         6413   manual handle
                                M code (4) in group A for backward movement by the retrace function by the
                         6414   manual handle
                                M code (1) in group B for backward movement by the retrace function by the
                         6415   manual handle
                                M code (2) in group B for backward movement by the retrace function by the
                         6416   manual handle
                                M code (3) in group B for backward movement by the retrace function by the
                         6417   manual handle
                                M code (4) in group B for backward movement by the retrace function by the
                         6418   manual handle
                                M code (1) in group C for backward movement by the retrace function by the
                         6419   manual handle
                                M code (2) in group C for backward movement by the retrace function by the
                         6420   manual handle
                                M code (3) in group C for backward movement by the retrace function by the
                         6421   manual handle
                                M code (4) in group C for backward movement by the retrace function by the
                         6422   manual handle
                                          280
B–63090EN/02                                         4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
                      M code (1) in group D for backward movement by the retrace function by the
               6423   manual handle
                      M code (2) in group D for backward movement by the retrace function by the
               6424   manual handle
                      M code (3) in group D for backward movement by the retrace function by the
               6425   manual handle
                      M code (4) in group D for backward movement by the retrace function by the
               6426   manual handle
                      M code (1) in group E for backward movement by the retrace function by the
               6427   manual handle
                      M code (2) in group E for backward movement by the retrace function by the
               6428   manual handle
                      M code (3) in group E for backward movement by the retrace function by the
               6429   manual handle
                      M code (4) in group E for backward movement by the retrace function by the
               6430   manual handle
                      M code (1) in group F for backward movement by the retrace function by the
               6431   manual handle
                      M code (2) in group F for backward movement by the retrace function by the
               6432   manual handle
                      M code (3) in group F for backward movement by the retrace function by the
               6433   manual handle
                      M code (4) in group F for backward movement by the retrace function by the
               6434   manual handle
                                281
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS                                                                    B–63090EN/02
                                M code (1) in group G for backward movement by the retrace function by the
                         6435   manual handle
                                M code (2) in group G for backward movement by the retrace function by the
                         6436   manual handle
                                M code (3) in group G for backward movement by the retrace function by the
                         6437   manual handle
                                M code (4) in group G for backward movement by the retrace function by the
                         6438   manual handle
                                M code (1) in group H for backward movement by the retrace function by the
                         6439   manual handle
                                M code (2) in group H for backward movement by the retrace function by the
                         6440   manual handle
                                M code (3) in group H for backward movement by the retrace function by the
                         6441   manual handle
                                M code (4) in group H for backward movement by the retrace function by the
                         6442   manual handle
                                M code (1) in group I for backward movement by the retrace function by the
                         6443   manual handle
                                M code (2) in group I for backward movement by the retrace function by the
                         6444   manual handle
                                M code (3) in group I for backward movement by the retrace function by the
                         6445   manual handle
                                M code (4) in group I for backward movement by the retrace function by the
                         6446   manual handle
                                          282
B–63090EN/02                                         4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
                      M code (1) in group J for backward movement by the retrace function by the
               6447   manual handle
                      M code (2) in group J for backward movement by the retrace function by the
               6448   manual handle
                      M code (3) in group J for backward movement by the retrace function by the
               6449   manual handle
                      M code (4) in group J for backward movement by the retrace function by the
               6450   manual handle
                      M code (1) in group K for backward movement by the retrace function by the
               6451   manual handle
                      M code (2) in group K for backward movement by the retrace function by the
               6452   manual handle
                      M code (3) in group K for backward movement by the retrace function by the
               6453   manual handle
                      M code (4) in group K for backward movement by the retrace function by the
               6454   manual handle
                      M code (1) in group L for backward movement by the retrace function by the
               6455   manual handle
                      M code (2) in group L for backward movement by the retrace function by the
               6456   manual handle
                      M code (3) in group L for backward movement by the retrace function by the
               6457   manual handle
                      M code (4) in group L for backward movement by the retrace function by the
               6458   manual handle
                                283
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS                                                                    B–63090EN/02
                                M code (1) in group M for backward movement by the retrace function by the
                         6459   manual handle
                                M code (2) in group M for backward movement by the retrace function by the
                         6460   manual handle
                                M code (3) in group M for backward movement by the retrace function by the
                         6461   manual handle
                                M code (4) in group M for backward movement by the retrace function by the
                         6462   manual handle
                                M code (1) in group N for backward movement by the retrace function by the
                         6463   manual handle
                                M code (2) in group N for backward movement by the retrace function by the
                         6464   manual handle
                                M code (3) in group N for backward movement by the retrace function by the
                         6465   manual handle
                                M code (4) in group N for backward movement by the retrace function by the
                         6466   manual handle
                                M code (1) in group O for backward movement by the retrace function by the
                         6467   manual handle
                                M code (2) in group O for backward movement by the retrace function by the
                         6468   manual handle
                                M code (3) in group O for backward movement by the retrace function by the
                         6469   manual handle
                                M code (4) in group O for backward movement by the retrace function by the
                         6470   manual handle
                                          284
B–63090EN/02                                         4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
                      M code (1) in group P for backward movement by the retrace function by the
               6471   manual handle
                      M code (2) in group P for backward movement by the retrace function by the
               6472   manual handle
                      M code (3) in group P for backward movement by the retrace function by the
               6473   manual handle
                      M code (4) in group P for backward movement by the retrace function by the
               6474   manual handle
                      M code (1) in group Q for backward movement by the retrace function by the
               6475   manual handle
                      M code (2) in group Q for backward movement by the retrace function by the
               6476   manual handle
                      M code (3) in group Q for backward movement by the retrace function by the
               6477   manual handle
                      M code (4) in group Q for backward movement by the retrace function by the
               6478   manual handle
                      M code (1) in group R for backward movement by the retrace function by the
               6479   manual handle
                      M code (2) in group R for backward movement by the retrace function by the
               6480   manual handle
                      M code (3) in group R for backward movement by the retrace function by the
               6481   manual handle
                      M code (4) in group R for backward movement by the retrace function by the
               6482   manual handle
                                285
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS                                                                         B–63090EN/02
                                     M code (1) in group S for backward movement by the retrace function by the
                           6483      manual handle
                                     M code (2) in group S for backward movement by the retrace function by the
                           6484      manual handle
                                     M code (3) in group S for backward movement by the retrace function by the
                           6485      manual handle
                                     M code (4) in group S for backward movement by the retrace function by the
                           6486      manual handle
                                     M code (1) in group T for backward movement by the retrace function by the
                           6487      manual handle
                                     M code (2) in group T for backward movement by the retrace function by the
                           6488      manual handle
                                     M code (3) in group T for backward movement by the retrace function by the
                           6489      manual handle
                                     M code (4) in group T for backward movement by the retrace function by the
                           6490      manual handle
                                               286
B–63090EN/02                              4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
               NOTE
                The names of the above parameters Nos. 6411 to 6490
                indicate those when 20 groups of four M codes are used for
                convenience of explanation.
                The actual numbers of groups and of M codes in each group
                are determined according to the settings of bits 3 (HM8) and
                2 (HM5) of parameter No. 6400. Also see the explanation
                of those parameters when setting the above parameters.
                          287
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS                                                            B–63090EN/02
4.38
PARAMETERS OF
GRAPHIC DISPLAY
4.38.1
                                      #7      #6       #5      #4      #3      #2       #1      #0
Parameters of Graphic
                                             NZM                      DPA
Display/Dynamic           6500
                                                      DPO
Graphic Display
                  [Data type] Bit
                      DPA Current position display on the graphic display screen
                          0 : Displays the actual position to ensure tool nose radius compensation
                          1 : Displays the programmed position
                      DPO Current position on the solid drawing (machining profile drawing) or tool
                          path drawing screen
                          0 : Not appear
                          1 : Appears
                      NZM 0 : The screen image is not enlarged by specifying the center of the screen
                              and magnification. (Screen image enlargement by a conventional
                              method is enabled.)
                          1 : The screen image is enlarged by specifying the center of the screen
                              and magnification. (Screen image enlargement by the conventional
                              method is disabled.)
                                      #7      #6       #5      #4      #3      #2       #1      #0
                                                      CSR
                          6501
                                                      CSR                                      ORG
                                      #7      #6       #5      #4      #3       #2      #1      #0
                                                                               CYG
                          6503
                                             288
B–63090EN/02                                                            4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
Z X
                                                         X                   Z
                                                                                      X
                                         Set value = 4       Set value = 5       Set value = 6       Set value = 7
                                              X
                                                         Z                                       X                   Z
                                                                       X              Z                       X
                                                    289
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS                                                                             B–63090EN/02
4.38.2
Parameters of Graphic       6561                      Standard color data for graphic color number 1
Color                       6562                      Standard color data for graphic color number 2
                [Unit of data] rr gg bb: 6–digit number (rr: Red gg: Green bb: Blue)
                               When a number of less than six digits is set, the system assumes that 0 has
                               been specified for the unspecified higher digit(s).
                                               290
B–63090EN/02                                                         4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
               [Valid data range] Data of each color: 00 to 15 (same value as the tone level data on the color
                                  setting screen)
                                  When a value of more than 15 is set, the system assumes that 15 has been
                                  specified.
                                    Example: Set 10203 in this parameter when the color tone levels are as
                                             follows:
                                             Red: 1 Green: 2 Blue: 3
                                     NOTE
                                      To set the color of the VGA display, use the color setting
                                      screen. Note that the color changes when the settings of
                                      parameters No.6561 through No.6595 are modified.
                                                   291
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS                                                                          B–63090EN/02
4.39
PARAMETERS OF
DISPLAYING
OPERATION TIME
AND NUMBER OF                           #7        #6        #5         #4        #3         #2       #1        #0
PARTS                       6700                                                                              PCM
                                       M code that counts the total number of machined parts and the number of ma-
                            6710
                                       chined parts
                                   NOTE
                                    Set value 0 is invalid (the number of parts is not counted for
                                    M00). Data 98 and 99 cannot be set.
                                   NOTE
                                    The number of parts is not counted for M02, M03, when bit
                                    0 (PCM) of parameter No. 6700 is set to 1.
                                                 292
B–63090EN/02                                                             4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
                                     NOTE
                                      The number of parts is not counted for M02, M03, when bit
                                      0 (PCM) of parameter No. 6700 is set to 1.
                                                   293
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS                                                                          B–63090EN/02
                                               294
B–63090EN/02                                                             4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
                                                   295
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS                                                                 B–63090EN/02
4.40
PARAMETERS OF                           #7         #6     #5      #4      #3         #2      #1        #0
TOOL LIFE                                                SNG     GRS      SIG       LTM     GS2       GS1
                          6800
MANAGEMENT                              M6T        IGI   SNG     GRS      SIG       LTM     GS2       GS1
                           The values on the lower row in the table apply when for the M series, the
                           512–tool–life–management–group option is provided.
                       LTM Tool life
                           0 : Specified by the number of times
                           1 : Specified by time
                        SIG Group number is
                            0 : Not input using the tool group signal during tool skip (The current
                                group is specified.)
                            1 : Input using the tool group signal during tool skip
                       GRS Tool exchange reset signal
                           0 : Clears only the execution data of a specified group
                           1 : Clears the execution data of all entered groups
                       SNG Input of the tool skip signal when a tool that is not considered tool life
                           management is selected.
                           0 : Skips the tool of the group used last or of the specified group (using
                               SIG, #3 of parameter No.6800).
                           1 : Ignores a tool skip signal
                        IGI Tool back number
                            0 : Not ignored
                            1 : Ignored
                       M6T T code in the same block as M06
                           0 : Judged as a back number
                           1 : Judged as a next tool group command
                                                  296
B–63090EN/02                                              4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
                                   #7      #6     #5      #4      #3      #2       #1      #0
                                          EXG     E1S                             TSM
                       6801
                                   M6E    EXT     E1S            EMD      LFV
                              NOTE
                               This parameter is valid when bit 2 (LTM) of parameter
                               No.6800 is set to 1.
                    EXT Specifies whether the extended tool life management function is used.
                        0 : Not used
                        1 : Used
                    EXG Tool life management data registration by G10 (T series) is:
                        0 : Performed after the data for all tool groups has been cleared.
                        1 : Performed by adding/changing or deleting the data for a specified
                            group.
                              NOTE
                               When EXG = 1, address P in the block including G10 can be
                               used to specify whether data is to be added/changed or
                               deleted (P1: add/change, P2: delete). When P is not
                               specified, the data for all tool groups is cleared before the
                               tool life management data is registered.
                                          297
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS                                                              B–63090EN/02
                                      #7      #6       #5      #4       #3       #2      #1      #0
                                                                                                 T99
                          6802
                                              TSK              ARL     GRP      E17     TCO      T99
                                             298
B–63090EN/02                                                 4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
                                   #7      #6       #5       #4        #3       #2       #1        #0
                                                                                         LFE      LGR
                       6803
                                                                                         LFE
                              NOTE
                               After this parameter has been set, the power must be turned
                               off then on again for the setting to become effective.
                                          299
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS                                                                    B–63090EN/02
                            6810
                                                         Tool life management ignored number
                            6844
                                                            Remaining tool life (use count)
                                   NOTE
                                   1 When the remaining life (use count) of a selected tool
                                     reaches the value specified with parameter No.6844, tool life
                                     arrival notice signal TLCHB is output to the PMC.
                                   2 If a value greater than the life of a tool is specified with
                                     parameter No.6844, the tool life arrival notice signal is not
                                     output.
                                                300
B–63090EN/02                                                         4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
                              6845
                                                            Remaining tool life (use duration)
                                     NOTE
                                     1 When the remaining life (use duration) of a selected tool
                                       reaches the value specified in parameter No.6845, tool life
                                       arrival notice signal TLCHB is output to the PMC. The tool
                                       life management function allows the user to specify a tool life
                                       either as a use duration or use count for each tool group. For
                                       a group whose life is specified as a use count, parameter
                                       No.6844 is used. For a group whose life is specified as a use
                                       time, parameter No.6845 is used.
                                     2 If a value greater than the life of a tool is specified with
                                       parameter No.6845, the tool life arrival notice signal is not
                                       output.
                                                 301
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS                                                         B–63090EN/02
4.41
PARAMETERS OF
POSITION SWITCH                       #7      #6     #5      #4      #3     #2      #1       #0
FUNCTIONS                 6901
                                                                    PSF    PCM     EPS      IGP
                                                                    PSF    PCM     EPS      IGP
                                 NOTE
                                  This parameter makes the position switch outputs more
                                  accurate in AI–look–ahead control mode or look–ahead
                                  control mode.
                                  When this parameter is set to 1, however, signals are output
                                  from the position switches at different times from the
                                  specified ones.
                                            302
B–63090EN/02                                                            4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
                                      NOTE
                                       Set 0 for the number corresponding to a position switch
                                       which is not to be used.
                                                303
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS                                                                                   B–63090EN/02
                                                     304
B–63090EN/02                                                                 4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
                                                        305
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS                                                                                 B–63090EN/02
4.42
PARAMETERS OF
MANUAL OPERATION
AND AUTOMATIC                                #7        #6        #5        #4        #3        #2          #1       #0
                              7001                                                                                  MIN
OPERATION
                    [Data type] Bit
                          MIN The manual intervention and return function is:
                              0 : Disabled.
                              1 : Enabled.
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0
                              7054
                                                                AIL                                        AIR
                                                      306
B–63090EN/02                                              4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0
                       7055
                                                                          ALZ     AF1     ACO
                                         307
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS                                                                        B–63090EN/02
4.43
PARAMETERS OF
MANUAL HANDLE
FEED, HANDLE
INTERRUPTION AND
HANDLE FEED IN                            #7          #6       #5       #4        #3      #2        #1        #0
TOOL AXIAL            7100                                                       HCL     IHD       THD       JHD
                                          #7          #6       #5       #4       #3      #2        #1         #0
                           7102                                                                              HNGx
                                                     308
B–63090EN/02                                                         4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
                                            #7     #6       #5        #4       #3        #2        #1   #0
                               7103                                  IBH       HIT      HNT       RHD
                                       NOTE
                                        This parameter is valid when bit 2 (IHD) of parameter No.
                                        7100 is set to 1.
                                                  309
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS                                                                           B–63090EN/02
7117 Allowable number of pulses that can be accumulated during manual handle feed
                                   NOTE
                                    If the specification of manual handle feed is such that the
                                    rapid traverse rate will be exceeded, for example, when the
                                    manual pulse generator is rotated at high speed with a large
                                    magnification such as 100, the axial feedrate is clamped
                                    at the rapid traverse rate and those pulses received from the
                                    manual pulse generator that exceed the rapid traverse rate
                                    are ignored. In such a case, therefore, the scale on the
                                    manual pulse generator may differ from the actual amount
                                    of travel. If such a difference is not acceptable, this
                                    parameter can be set to temporarily accumulate the excess
                                    pulses in the CNC, rather than ignoring them, up to the
                                    specified maximum (pulses in excess of the set maximum
                                    are ignored). The accumulated pulses are output and
                                    converted to a move command once the feedrate falls below
                                    the rapid traverse rate by reducing the rotational speed of
                                    the manual pulse generator or stopping its rotation
                                    altogether. Note, however, that if the maximum number of
                                    pulses to be accumulated is too large, stopping the rotation
                                    of the manual pulse generator does not stop feeding until the
                                    tool moves by an amount corresponding to the pulses
                                    accumulated in the CNC.
                                                 310
B–63090EN/02                                                              4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
4.44
PARAMETERS OF
MANUAL LINE AND
ARC FUNCTIONS
                               7160
                                                                Approach handle clamp feedrate
                               7161
                                                                Guidance handle clamp feedrate
                                                       311
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS                                                                             B–63090EN/02
4.45
PARAMETERS OF
REFERENCE
POSITION SETTING
WITH MECHANICAL
STOPPER                    7181         First withdrawal distance in reference position setting with mechanical stopper
                                  NOTE
                                   Set the same direction as that set in bit 5 (ZMIx) of parameter
                                   No. 1006. Cycle operation cannot be started if the opposite
                                   direction is set.
7182 Second withdrawal distance in reference position setting with mechanical stopper
                                  NOTE
                                   Set the same direction as that set in bit 5 (ZMIx) of parameter
                                   No. 1006. Cycle operation cannot be started if the opposite
                                   direction is set.
                                                 312
B–63090EN/02                                                                4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
7183 First butting feedrate in reference position setting with mechanical stopper
                                  When the reference position setting with mechanical stopper is used, this
                                  parameter sets the feedrate first used to hit the stopper on an axis.
7184 Second butting feedrate in reference position setting with mechanical stopper
                                  When the reference position setting with mechanical stopper is used, this
                                  parameter sets the feedrate used to hit the stopper on an axis for a second
                                  time.
                                  When the reference position setting with mechanical stopper is used, this
                                  parameter sets the feedrate used for withdrawal along an axis after the
                                  mechanical stopper has been hit.
7186 Torque limit value in reference position setting with mechanical stopper
                                      NOTE
                                        When 0 is set in this parameter, 100% is assumed.
                                                      313
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS                                                          B–63090EN/02
4.46
PARAMETERS OF
SOFTWARE
OPERATOR’S PANEL
                                    #7       #6      #5      #4      #3      #2      #1     #0
                          7200              OP7     OP6     OP5     OP4     OP3     OP2     OP1
                                    #7      #6       #5      #4       #3     #2      #1      #0
                          7201                                                              JPC
                                           314
B–63090EN/02                                                                4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
7210 Job–movement axis and its direction on software operator’s panel ȱ↑ȴ
7211 Job–movement axis and its direction on software operator’s panel ȱ↓ȴ
7212 Job–movement axis and its direction on software operator’s panel ȱ→ȴ
7213 Job–movement axis and its direction on software operator’s panel ȱ←ȴ
                                 7216
                                                Job–movement axis and its direction on software operator’s panel ȱ   ȴ
                                 7217
                                                Job–movement axis and its direction on software operator’s panel ȱ   ȴ
                             0          Not moved
                             1          First axis, positive direction
                             2          First axis, negative direction               7               8               9
                             3          Second axis, positive direction
                             4          Second axis, negative direction
                             5          Third axis, positive direction
                                                                                     4              5                6
                             6          Third axis, negative direction
                             7          Fourth axis, positive direction
                             8          Fourth axis, negative direction
                                                                                     1              2                3
Example                               Under X, Y, and Z axis configuration, to set arrow keys to feed the axes
                                      in the direction specified as follows, set the parameters to the values given
                                      below. [8 °] to the positive direction of the Z axis, [2 ±] to the negative
                                      direction of the Z axis, [6 ³] to the positive direction of the X axis [4²]
                                      to the negative direction of the X axis, [1¼] to the positive direction of
                                      the Y axis, [9½] to the negative direction of the Y axis
                                          Parameter No.7210 = 5 (Z axis, positive direction)
                                          Parameter No.7211 = 6 (Z axis, negative direction)
                                          Parameter No.7212 = 1 (X axis, positive direction)
                                          Parameter No.7213 = 2 (X axis, negative direction)
                                          Parameter No.7214 = 3 (Y axis, positive direction)
                                          Parameter No.7215 = 4 (Y axis, negative direction)
                                          Parameter No.7216 = 0 (Not used)
                                          Parameter No.7217 = 0 (Not used)
                                                      315
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS                                                                      B–63090EN/02
Example
                             These parameters set the          OPERATOR’S PANEL             O1234 N5678
                             names of the                          SIGNAL1          :    OFF       ON
                             general–purpose switches              SIGNAL2          :    OFF       ON
                             (SIGNAL 1 through                     SIGNAL3          :    OFF       ON
                             SIGNAL 8) on the                      SIGNAL4          :    OFF       ON
                             software operator’s panel             SIGNAL5          :    OFF       ON
                             as described below.                   SIGNAL6          :    OFF       ON
                                                                   SIGNAL7          :    OFF       ON
                                                                   SIGNAL8          :    OFF       ON
                               These names are set using character codes that are displayed in parameter
                               Nos. 7220 to 7283.
                               Parameter No.7220:
                                  Sets the character code (083) corresponding to S of SIGNAL 1.
                               Parameter No.7221:
                                  Sets the character code (073) corresponding to I of SIGNAL 1.
                               Parameter No.7222:
                                  Sets the character code (071) corresponding to G of SIGNAL 1.
                               Parameter No.7223:
                                  Sets the character code (078) corresponding to N of SIGNAL 1.
                               Parameter No.7224:
                                  Sets the character code (065) corresponding to A of SIGNAL 1.
                               Parameter No.7225:
                                  Sets the character code (076) corresponding to L of SIGNAL 1.
                               Parameter No.7226:
                                  Sets the character code (032) corresponding to (space) of SIGNAL 1.
                               Parameter No.7227:
                                  Sets the character code (049) corresponding to 1 of SIGNAL 1.
                               Parameter Nos. 7228 to 7235:
                                  Set the character codes of SIGNAL 2 shown in the figure above.
                               Parameter Nos. 7236 to 7243:
                                  Set the character codes of SIGNAL 3 shown in the figure above.
                               Parameter Nos. 7244 to 7251:
                                  Set the character codes of SIGNAL 4 shown in the figure above.
                               Parameter Nos. 7252 to 7259:
                                  Set the character codes of SIGNAL 5 shown in the figure above.
                               Parameter Nos. 7260 to 7267:
                                  Set the character codes of SIGNAL 6 shown in the figure above.
                               Parameter Nos. 7268 to 7275:
                                  Set the character codes of SIGNAL 7 shown in the figure above.
                               Parameter Nos. 7276 to 7283:
                                  Set the character codes of SIGNAL 8 shown in the figure above.
                               The character codes are shown in Appendix A CHARACTER CODE
                               LIST.
                                             316
B–63090EN/02                                                      4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
                          These names are set using the character codes displayed in parameters
                          No.7284 through No.7299, and parameters No.7352 through No.7399.
                              Parameter No.7284:
                                  Set the character code (083) corresponding to S of SIGNAL 9.
                              Parameter No.7285:
                                  Set the character code (073) corresponding to I of SIGNAL 9.
                              Parameter No.7286:
                                  Set the character code (071) corresponding to G of SIGNAL 9.
                              Parameter No.7287:
                                  Set the character code (078) corresponding to N of SIGNAL 9.
                              Parameter No.7288:
                                  Set the character code (065) corresponding to A of SIGNAL 9.
                              Parameter No.7289:
                                  Set the character code (076) corresponding to L of SIGNAL 9.
                              Parameter No.7290:
                                  Set the character code (032) corresponding to (space) of SIGNAL 9.
                              Parameter No.7291:
                                  Set the character code (057) corresponding to 9 of SIGNAL 9.
                          Similarly, set character codes as shown below.
                              Parameter No.7292 to No.7299:       Set character codes for SIGNAL 10, shown above.
                              Parameter No.7352 to No.7359:       Set character codes for SIGNAL 11, shown above.
                              Parameter No.7360 to No.7367:       Set character codes for SIGNAL 12, shown above.
                              Parameter No.7368 to No.7375:       Set character codes for SIGNAL 13, shown above.
                              Parameter No.7376 to No.7383:       Set character codes for SIGNAL 14, shown above.
                              Parameter No.7384 to No.7391:       Set character codes for SIGNAL 15, shown above.
                              Parameter No.7392 to No.7399:       Set character codes for SIGNAL 16, shown above.
                          The character codes are shown in the character code correspondence table
                          in Appendix A.
                                            317
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS                                                                         B–63090EN/02
4.47
PARAMETERS OF
PROGRAM RESTART                         #7      #6         #5        #4        #3        #2          #1     #0
                                       MOU     MOA
                            7300
                                       MOU     MOA                            SJG
                                   NOTE
                                    This parameter is enabled when the MOU parameter is set
                                    to 1.
                                              318
B–63090EN/02                                                       4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
4.48
PARAMETERS OF
HIGH–SPEED
MACHINING (HIGH–
SPEED REMOTE                           #7      #6      #5          #4      #3       #2      #1       #0
BUFFER)                   7501        IPC      IT2     IT1         IT0
                        IPC
                               0 : The system does not monitor whether a distribution process is
                                   stopped with high–speed remote buffer A or B.
                               1 : The system monitors whether a distribution process is stopped with
                                   high–speed remote buffer A or B.
                                   (P/S alarms 179 and 000 are simultaneously issued if the distribution
                                   process is stopped. In this case, the power must be turned off then on
                                   again.)
                                 NOTE
                                  The distribution process stops, when the host cannot send
                                  data with the high–speed remotebuffer by the specified time.
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0
                          7502
                                                                                                    SUP
                                              319
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS                                                                           B–63090EN/02
                                        #7    #6          #5        #4         #3        #2            #1     #0
                           7505                                                                              HSCx
                                  NOTE
                                   After setting this parameter, the power must be tuned off
                                   then on again.
                                             320
B–63090EN/02                                              4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
4.49
PARAMETERS OF
POLYGON TURNING                    #7      #6     #5       #4      #3      #2       #1      #0
                                   PLZ
                       7600
                                   #7      #6      #5      #4     #3       #2       #1      #0
                                                  COF     HST     HSL     HDR      SNG     MNG
                       7602
                              NOTE
                               Use MNG, SNG, and HDR when the specified rotational
                               direction of the master axis or polygon synchronization axis,
                               or the specified phase shift direction is to be reversed in
                               spindle–spindle polygon turning mode.
                                          321
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS                                                            B–63090EN/02
                                 NOTE
                                  This parameter can be used, for example, when
                                  single–rotation signal detection cannot be guaranteed at an
                                  arbitrary feedrate because a separate detector is installed to
                                  detect the spindle single–rotation signal, as when a built–in
                                  spindle is used. (When bit 7 of parameter No.4016 for the
                                  serial spindle is set to 1, together with this parameter, a
                                  single–rotation signal detection position in spindle–spindle
                                  polygon turning mode is guaranteed.)
                                 NOTE
                                  When the use of phase control is not selected, the steady state
                                  is reached in a shorter time because phase synchronization
                                  control is not applied. Once steady rotation is achieved,
                                  however, polygonal turning must be completed without
                                  changing the steady state. (If the rotation is stopped, or the
                                  rotational speed altered, polygonal turning is disabled because
                                  of the inevitable phase shift.) Even when this parameter is set
                                  to 1, an R command (phase position command) in a block
                                  containing G51.2 is ignored ; no alarm is issued.
                                      #7      #6      #5       #4      #3      #2       #1     #0
                                      PST            RDG              PLR     SBR      QDR     RPL
                          7603
                                 NOTE
                                   This parameter is used to set the slave spindle speed to a
                                   multiple of the master spindle speed when the spindle
                                   synchronization function is used.
                                 1 This parameter is not related to the setting of the polygon
                                   turning function option.
                                 2 The spindle synchronization option is needed.
                                 3 Parameter Nos. 7635 and 7636 also need be set up.
                                             322
B–63090EN/02                                                                 4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
                            PLR The machine coordinates of a tool axis for polygon turning are:
                                0 : Rounded by the setting in parameter 7620.
                                1 : Rounded by 360° (or the setting in parameter No. 1260 when bit 0
                                    (ROA) of parameter No. 1008 is set to 1).
                            RDG On the diagnosis screen No.476, for spindle–spindle polygon phase
                                command value (R), displays:
                                0 : The specified value (in the increment system for the rotation axis).
                                1 : The actual number of shift pulses.
                                       NOTE
                                        A phase command is specified in address R, in units of
                                        degrees. For control, the actual shift amount is converted to
                                        a number of pulses according to the conversion formula: 360
                                        degrees = 4096 pulses. This parameter switches the display
                                        of a specified value to that of a converted value.
                             PST The polygon spindle stop signal *PLSST (bit 0 of G038) is:
                                 0 : Not used.
                                 1 : Used.
                                                       323
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS                                                                              B–63090EN/02
                                       Maximum allowable speed for the tool rotation axis (polygon synchronization axis)
                              7621
                                                  324
B–63090EN/02                                                          4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
                                      NOTE
                                        This parameter is used to set the slave spindle speed to a
                                        multiple of the master spindle speed when the spindle
                                        synchronization function is used.
                                      1 This parameter is not related to the setting of the polygon
                                        turning function option.
                                      2 The spindle synchronization option is needed.
                                      3 Parameter Nos. 7603#2 and 7636 also need be set up.
                                      NOTE
                                        This parameter is used to set the slave spindle speed to a
                                        multiple of the master spindle speed when the spindle
                                        synchronization function is used.
                                      1 This parameter is not related to the setting of the polygon
                                        turning function option.
                                      2 The spindle synchronization option is needed.
                                      3 Parameter Nos. 7603#2 and 7635 also need be set up.
                                                 325
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS                                                                           B–63090EN/02
                                   NOTE
                                   1 Spindle–spindle polygon turning is enabled only for serial
                                     spindles.
                                   2 When either of parameters No. 7640 and No. 7641 is set to
                                     0, the first spindle (master axis) and second spindle (polygon
                                     synchronous axis) are used for polygon turning.
                                   3 When the second serial spindle is used as a master axis, and
                                     the S command is to be used for the master axis, the
                                     multi–spindle control option is required.
                                   4 When the PMC window function or G10 command is used
                                     to rewrite this parameter, rewrite this parameter before the
                                     block specifying the spindle–spindle polygon command
                                     G51.2 (G251). When the PMC window function is used to
                                     rewrite this parameter in the block immediately before G51.2
                                     (G251), specify the rewriting of this parameter by using an
                                     M code (parameter No. 3411 and up) without buffering.
                                               326
B–63090EN/02                                              4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
4.50
PARAMETERS OF
AXIS CONTROL BY                    #7     #6      #5      #4      #3      #2      #1       #0
PMC                    8001       SKE    AUX     NCC             RDE     OVE               MLE
                              NOTE
                               Each–axis machine lock signals MLK1 to MLK4 are always
                               valid, regardless of the setting of this parameter.
                    OVE Signals related to dry run and override used in PMC axis control
                        0: Same signals as those used for the CNC
                           (1) Feedrate override signals *FV0 to *FV7
                           (2) Override cancellation signal OVC
                           (3) Rapid traverse override signals ROV1 and ROV2
                           (4) Dry run signal DRN
                           (5) Rapid traverse selection signal RT
                        1: Signals specific to the PMC
                           (1) Feedrate override signals *FV0E to *FV7E
                           (2) Override cancellation signal OVCE
                           (3) Rapid traverse override signals ROV1E and ROV2E
                           (4) Dry run signal DRNE
                           (5) Rapid traverse selection signal RTE
                    RDE Whether dry run is valid for rapid traverse in PMC axis control
                        0 : Invalid
                        1 : Valid
                    NCC When a travel command is issued for a PMC–controlled axis (selected by
                        a controlled–axis selection signal) according to the program:
                        0 : P/S alarm 139 is issued while the PMC controls the axis with an axis
                            control command. While the PMC does not control the axis, a CNC
                            command is enabled.
                        1 : P/S alarm 139 is issued unconditionally.
                    AUX The number of bytes for the code of an auxiliary function (12H) command
                        to be output is
                        0 : 1 (0 to 255)
                        1 : 2 (0 to 65535)
                    SKE Skip signal during axis control by the PMC
                        0 : Uses the same signal SKIP (X004#7) as CNC.
                        1 : Uses dedicated axis control signal ESKIP (X004#6) used by the
                            PMC.
                                         327
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS                                                                         B–63090EN/02
                                       #7        #6        #5        #4         #3       #2          #1     #0
                          8002         FR2      FR1        PF2       PF1        F10     SUE         DWE    RPD
                   PF1, PF2 Set the the feedrate unit of feed per minute in PMC axis control
                                    PF2            PF1          Feedrate unit
                                     0              0                1/1
                                     0              1               1/10
                                     1              0              1/100
                                     1              1              1/1000
                  FR1, FR2 Set the feedrate unit for feed per rotation for an axis controlled by the
                           PMC.
                                 FR2         FR1      Millimeter input             Inch input
                                  0           0
                                                         0.0001 mm/rev          0.000001 inch/rev
                                  1           1
                                  0           1          0.001 mm/rev           0.00001 inch/rev
                                  1           0           0.01 mm/rev           0.0001 inch/rev
                                                328
B–63090EN/02                                               4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
                                   #7      #6      #5      #4       #3      #2       #1      #0
                       8003                                                         PAX
                              NOTE
                               When this parameter is set, the power must be turned off
                               before operation is continued.
                                   #7     #6      #5       #4       #3      #2       #1      #0
                       8004        NDI    NCI     DSL                               NMT     CMV
                                          NCI     DSL      G8R     G8C              NMT     CMV
                   CMV When a move command and auxiliary function are specified from the
                       CNC, and the system is awaiting the auxiliary function completion signal
                       after completion of the specified axis movement:
                       0 : An alarm (No.130) is issued when an axis control command is issued
                           from the PMC for the same axis.
                       1 : An axis control command, when issued from the PMC for the same
                           axis, is executed.
                   NMT When a command is specified from the CNC for the axis on which the tool
                       is moving according to axis control specification from the PMC:
                       0 : P/S alarm No.130 is issued.
                       1 : The command is executed without issuing an alarm, provided the
                           command does not involve a movement on the axis.
                    G8C Look–ahead control for the axes controlled by the PMC is:
                        0 : Disabled.
                        1 : Enabled.
                              NOTE
                               This parameter is valid for an axis for which bit 7 (NAHx) of
                               parameter No.1819 is set to 0.
                              NOTE
                               This parameter is valid for an axis for which bit 7 (NAHx) of
                               parameter No.1819 is set to 0.
                    DSL If the selection of an axis is changed when PMC axis selection is disabled:
                        0 : P/S alarm No.139 is issued.
                        1 : The change is valid, and no alarm is issued for an unspecified system.
                                          329
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS                                                              B–63090EN/02
                        NCI In axis control by the PMC, a position check at the time of deceleration is:
                            0 : Performed.
                            1 : Not performed.
                        NDI For PMC axis control, when diameter programming is specified for a
                            PMC–controlled axis:
                            0 : The amount of travel and feedrate are each specified with a radius.
                            1 : The amount of travel and feedrate are each specified with a diameter.
                                  NOTE
                                   NDI is valid for an axis for which diameter programming is
                                   specified (bit 3 (DIAx) of parameter No. 1006 is set to 1)
                                   when bit 1 (CDI) of parameter No. 8005 is set to 0.
                                       #7      #6       #5      #4      #3      #2       #1       #0
                           8005       MFD              IFV             DRR      R10      CDI     EDC
                                  NOTE
                                  1 This parameter is valid when bit 3 (DIA) of parameter
                                    No.1006 is set to 1.
                                  2 When CDI is set to 1, bit 7 (NDI) of parameter No.8004 is
                                    disabled.
                        R10 When the RPD parameter (bit 0 of parameter No.8002) is set to 1, the unit
                            for specifying a rapid traverse rate for the PMC axis is:
                            0 : 1 mm/min.
                            1 : 10 mm/min.
                       DRR For cutting feed per rotation in PMC axis control, the dry run function is:
                           0 : Disabled.
                           1 : Enabled.
                        IFV Override for each group in PMC axis control is:
                            0 : Disabled.
                            1 : Enabled.
                       MFD Output by each auxiliary function of the PMC axis control function is:
                           0 : Disabled.
                           1 : Enabled.
                                             330
B–63090EN/02                                                                    4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
                                              #7           #6       #5            #4     #3            #2     #1          #0
                               8006                                                                   IPA    EML
                                              #7           #6       #5            #4     #3           #2      #1           #0
                               8008                                                                                       MIRx
8010 Selection of the DI/DO group for each axis controlled by the PMC
8020 Low–speed feedrate at reference position return in axis control by PMC (FL)
                                                        331
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS                                                                                      B–63090EN/02
                                   NOTE
                                    If 0 is specified, the value of parameter No. 1425 is used.
8021 Minimum speed of rapid traverse override in axis control by PMC (Fo)
8022 Upper–limit rate of feed per revolution during PMC axis control
                                This parameter sets the upper limit rate of feed per revolution during PMC
                                axis control.
                                   NOTE
                                    The upper limit specified for the first axis is valid for all axes.
                                    The specifications for the second and subsequent axes are
                                    ignored.
8028 Linear acceleration/deceleration time constant for speed commands for PMC axis control
                                   NOTE
                                    If this parameter is set to 0, acceleration/deceleration control
                                    is not applied.
                                                     332
B–63090EN/02                                               4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
4.51
PARAMETERS OF
ANGULAR AXIS
CONTROL                            #7      #6      #5       #4       #3      #2      #1       #0
                                                                    AZP     AZR              AAC
                       8200
                              NOTE
                                When this parameter is set, the power must be turned off
                                before operation is continued.
                                   #7      #6       #5      #4      #3       #2       #1      #0
                                  ADG              ACL                      AO3      AO2     AOT
                       8201
                                         333
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS                                                                            B–63090EN/02
                        ACL In linear interpolation type rapid traverse, the feedrate clamp function for
                            angular axis control is:
                            0 : Enabled.
                            1 : Disabled.
                                   NOTE
                                    This parameter is valid when bit 1 (LRP) of parameter No.
                                    1401 is set to 1.
                        ADG The contents of diagnostic data Nos. 306 and 307 are:
                            0 : Not swapped. The angular axis and Cartesian axis are displayed in
                                this order.
                            1 : Swapped. The Cartesian axis and angular axis are displayed in this
                                order.
                                                                            +X (angular axis):
                                                                               Actual movement coordinate system
                                                                    θ
+Z (orthogonal axis)
θ : Inclination angle
                                               334
B–63090EN/02                                              4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
4.52
PARAMETERS OF
B–AXIS CONTROL
                                  #7       #6      #5      #4      #3      #2       #1      #0
                                 MST      ABS     SOV     TEM     REF
                       8240
                                  #7      #6       #5      #4      #3       #2      #1      #0
                                                                           MDF     MDG     FXC
                       8241
                                         335
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS                                                                              B–63090EN/02
                                         #7        #6        #5         #4         #3         #2         #1        #0
                                                                                                        BPF
                            8242
                                                 336
B–63090EN/02                                                           4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
This parameter sets the clearance used for peck drilling cycle G83.
G83
                                         q                                           q : Depth of cut
                                                                         d           d : Clearance
                                         q
                                                                         d
                                                                                                 Rapid traverse
                                         q                                                       Cutting feed
                                                                         d
Point B
                                                  337
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS                                                            B–63090EN/02
4.53
PARAMETERS OF
SIMPLE                                #7      #6      #5      #4       #3      #2      #1       #0
SYNCHRONOUS               8301
                                     SOF             SYE      SYA
CONTROL
                  [Data type] Bit
                       SYA In the servo–off state in simple synchronous control, the limit of the
                           difference between the positioning deviation of the master axis and that of
                           the slave axis is:
                           0 : Not checked.
                           1 : Checked.
                       SYE During execution of synchronization, the limit of the difference between
                           positioning deviations (parameter No. 8313 or 8323) is:
                           0 : Checked.
                           1 : Not checked.
                       SOF The synchronization funciton in simple synchronous control (one pair) is:
                           0 : Not used.
                           1 : Used.
                                      #7      #6      #5      #4       #3      #2      #1       #0
                          8302
                                     SMA                              SSE              ATS     ATE
                                 NOTE
                                  When this parameter is set, the power must be turned off
                                  before operation is continued.
                                 NOTE
                                 1 When the bits are set to 1, parameter No.8316 and bit 4
                                   (APZx) of parameter No.1815 for the master and slave axes
                                   are set to 0.
                                 2 These bits are automatically set to 0 once grid positioning
                                   has been completed.
                                            338
B–63090EN/02                                               4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
                               NOTE
                                The simple synchronous signal must be manipulated.
                                Carefully turn the simple synchronous signal on and off
                                because the machine may move at that time.
                    SMA When bit 4x (APZx) of parameter No. 1015 is turned off for one axis under
                        simple synchronous control, APZx for the other axis under simple
                        synchronous control is:
                        0 : Not turned off.
                        1 : Turned off.
                           When an axis for which the simple synchronous axis parameter is set is
                           under simple synchronous control, the simple synchronous signal is
                           turned on for the axis.
                                    #7     #6      #5      #4       #3      #2      #1       #0
                        8303
                                   SOFx                                            ATSx     ATEx
                               NOTE
                                After this parameter has been set, the power must be turned
                                off then on again for the setting to become effective.
                               NOTE
                                When starting automatic setting for grid positioning, set
                                ATSx to 1. Upon the completion of setting, ATSx is
                                automatically set to 0.
                               NOTE
                                Set this parameter on the master axis side.
                                          339
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS                                                          B–63090EN/02
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0
                           8304
                                                                                            USD
                                  NOTE
                                   Set this parameter (USD) to the same value for both the
                                   master and slave axes.
#7 #6 #5 #4 #3 #2 #1 #0
                           8305
                                                                                    USE     USC
                                  NOTE
                                   This parameter is valid only when bit 7 (SOF) of parameter
                                   No. 8301 or bit 7 (SOFx) of parameter No. 8303 is set to 1.
                                  NOTE
                                   This parameter is valid only when bit 7 (SOF) of parameter
                                   No. 8301 or bit 7 (SOFx) of parameter No. 8303 is set to 1.
                                             340
B–63090EN/02                                                            4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
                                      NOTE
                                       When this parameter is set, the power must be turned off
                                       before operation is continued.
                                      NOTE
                                       For an axis for which 0 is set, the first axis serves as the
                                       master axis. So, when the control signal for the axis is set
                                       to 1, the first axis serves as a master axis, and synchronous
                                       control is exercised.
                                                    341
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS                                                                             B–63090EN/02
                                      NOTE
                                       The axis number of a master axis must always be smaller
                                       than the corresponding slave axis number. Multiple slave
                                       axes cannot be assigned to a master axis.
                                                    342
B–63090EN/02                                                                4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
                               8313        Limit of the difference between the amount of positioning deviation of the master
                                           and slave axes (Synchronous control one pair)
                               8314
                                                            Maximum error in synchronization error check
                               8315
                                           Maximum compensation value for synchronization (Synchronous control one pair)
                                      NOTE
                                       When this parameter is set, the power must be turned off
                                       before operation is continued.
                                                     343
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS                                                                             B–63090EN/02
                            8316       Difference between reference counters for master and slave axes
                                       (Synchronous control one pair)
                                   NOTE
                                    When this parameter is set, the power must be turned off
                                    before operation is continued.
                                   NOTE
                                    Once grid positioning has been completed, the difference
                                    between the reference counters is automatically set in this
                                    parameter. At this time, bit 1 (ATS) of parameter No.8302 is
                                    set to 0.
                            8317
                                           Torque difference alarm detection time (Synchronous control one pair)
                                                344
B–63090EN/02                                                               4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
                              8318       Detection timer for the limit of the difference between the positioning deviation of
                                         the master axis and that of the slave axis
                                     NOTE
                                      If a value greater than 1000 is set, a value of 1000 is
                                      assumed.
                              8323
                                        Maximum allowable difference between master axis and slave axis positional deviations
                              8325
                                                          Maximum compensation value for synchronization
                                                    345
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS                                                                        B–63090EN/02
                           8326
                                           Difference between master axis and slave axis reference counters
                           8327
                                                        Torque difference alarm detection timer
                                                346
B–63090EN/02                                                         4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
4.54
PARAMETERS OF
CHECK
TERMINATION
                              8341                    Program number subject to check termination
                                     NOTE
                                      A program number can also be set on the setting screen. If
                                      a program number is set on the setting screen, the value of
                                      the parameter is changed accordingly.
                                     NOTE
                                      A sequence number can also be set by using the setting
                                      screen. If a sequence number is set on the setting screen,
                                      the value of the parameter is changed accordingly.
                                                347
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS                                                              B–63090EN/02
4.55
                                      #7       #6      #5       #4      #3       #2      #1       #0
OTHER                     8650                        PGU      CKM     DMA      EKY     CNA      RSK
PARAMETERS
                  [Data type] Bit
                       RSK When the RESET key is pressed, the key code is:
                           0 : Not passed to the application in the C executor.
                           1 : Passed to the application in the C executor.
                       CNA When an NC alarm is issued during the display of the user screen for the C
                           executor:
                           0 : The NC alarm screen can be displayed depending on the setting of bit
                               7 (NPA) of parameter No.3111.
                           1 : The NC alarm screen is not displayed.
                       EKY When the C language executor is used, the extended portion of the MDI
                           keys (9 to 11 lines) is:
                           0 : Not read.
                           1 : Read.
                      DMA When the C language executor is used, transfer via RS–232–C is:
                          0 : Not made as DMA transfer.
                          1 : Made as DMA transfer.
                      CKM When the C language executor is used, the bit matrix of the MDI keys is:
                          0 : Not transferred to the NC.
                          1 : Transferred to the NC.
                               Set this bit to 1 only when the NC needs to directly read the bit matrix.
                               Usually, set this bit to 0.
                       PGU When the user screen for the C executor is assigned as an NC program
                           screen:
                           0 : The common screen number is used.
                           1 : The screen number for each operation mode is used.
                                 NOTE
                                  Bits 0 to 5 of this parameter is used with the C executor. Any
                                  modifications to the value set for bits 0 to 5 of this parameter
                                  does not become effective until after the system is next
                                  powered on.
                                      #7       #6      #5       #4      #3       #2      #1      #0
                          8651                                                                   CFS
                                 NOTE
                                  When this parameter has been set, the power must be
                                  turned off before operation is contimued.
                                             348
B–63090EN/02                                                      4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
                                      NOTE
                                       This parameter is used for C executer. When this setting is
                                       changed, the variable area is initialized. A change in this
                                       setting is applied at the next power–up or later.
                                      NOTE
                                       This parameter is used for C executer. When this setting is
                                       changed, the SRAM disk is initialized. A change in this
                                       setting is applied at the next power–up or later.
                                      NOTE
                                       This parameter is used for C executer. A change in this
                                       setting is applied at the next power–up or later.
                                                  349
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS                                                          B–63090EN/02
                                      #7     #6      #5      #4      #3      #2      #1      #0
                          8700                                      DMM
                                      #7     #6      #5      #4      #3      #2       #1     #0
                          8701                                              WPR      PLD
                                 NOTE
                                  If this parameter is set, a move command based on manual
                                  operation is disabled (interlock state) while parameter
                                  rewriting using the PMC window is being executed.
                                      #7     #6      #5      #4      #3      #2      #1      #0
                          8702       LFM
                                            350
B–63090EN/02                                             4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
                                    #7     #6     #5     #4     #3      #2      #1      #0
                       8706                                                    NWD     HSD
                              NOTE
                               When this parameter has been set, the power must be
                               turned off before operation is contimued.
                              NOTE
                               For details of this parameter, also refer to “FANUC Open
                               CNC DNC Operation Management Package” and other
                               manuals.
                   NWD During DNC operation with FOCAS1/HSSB, new DNC functions are:
                       0 : Not executed.
                       1 : Executed.
                           When this parameter is set, the M198 command (subprogram call) can
                           also be executed with FOCAS1/HSSB.
                              NOTE
                               To execute the M198 command with FOCAS1/HSSB,
                               parameter No. 20 must be set to “15”.
                                 For details of this parameter, also refer to “FANUC Open
                                 CNC DNC Operation Management Package” and other
                                 manuals.
                                          351
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS                                                                              B–63090EN/02
                                       Program number for data registration (data input/output function using the
                            8760
                                       I/O link)
                                   NOTE
                                    When 0 is set, the input/output of parameters, macro
                                    variables, and diagnostic data cannot be performed, but
                                    program input/output processing is performed.
                                   NOTE
                                    When this parameter is set, the power must be turned off
                                    before operation is continued.
                                                  352
B–63090EN/02                                                             4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
                                       NOTE
                                        The available size depends on the amount of installed
                                        DRAM and the selected options.
                                             #7       #6       #5        #4         #3        #2         #1   #0
                                8802
                                       NOTE
                                        These parameters are used only by the machine tool builder.
                                        Refer to the relevant manual supplied by the machine tool
                                        builder for details.
                                       NOTE
                                        These parameters are used only by the machine tool builder.
                                        Refer to the relevant manual supplied by the machine tool
                                        builder for details.
                                                     353
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS                                                                           B–63090EN/02
4.56
PARAMETERS OF
MAINTENANCE                           #7         #6        #5         #4         #3         #2        #1         #0
                           8901                                                                                 FAN
                                      #7         #6        #5         #4         #3         #2        #1         #0
                           8903                                                                                 PRM
8911 Ratio of the items on the periodic maintenance screen to the respective lives
                                               354
B–63090EN/02                                                            4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
4.57
PARAMETERS OF
BUILT–IN MACRO
                                           #7       #6        #5         #4        #3           #2      #1            #0
                              12001                                                                                  IMR
                                      NOTE
                                      1 This parameter is rewritten by the built–in macro data in
                                        FROM at power–up or at a reload operation.
                                      2 If the key of parameter No. 12013 is locked, the built–in
                                        macro data in FROM is used.
                                      NOTE
                                      1 This parameter is rewritten by the built–in macro data in
                                        FROM at power–up or at a reload operation.
                                      2 If the key of parameter No. 12013 is locked, the built–in
                                        macro data in FROM is used.
                                                  355
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS                                                                 B–63090EN/02
                                   NOTE
                                   1 This parameter is rewritten by the built–in macro data in
                                     FROM at power–up or at a reload operation.
                                   2 If the key of parameter No. 12013 is locked, the built–in
                                     macro data in FROM is used.
                                   3 This parameter cannot be changed if a key for built–in macro
                                     is locked or if at least a single NC program is provided.
                                               356
B–63090EN/02                                                           4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
                                      NOTE
                                      1 If the password is not zero, the password cannot be changed
                                        for the built–in macro data.
                                      2 If all of the following conditions are satisfied, the keyword
                                        cannot be changed.
                                        1) A password is specified. (Password is not zero.)
                                        2) The macro program number range of the built–in data of
                                            FROM is different from the built–in macro program
                                            number range specified in the parameter.
                                        3) A program is entered.
                                      NOTE
                                      1 This parameter is rewritten by the built–in macro data in
                                        FROM at power–up or at a reload operation.
                                      2 If the key of parameter No. 12013 is locked, the built–in
                                        macro data in FROM is used.
                                      3 If this parameter is set to 0, the series or edition of the FROM
                                        file for built–in macro is not displayed on the system
                                        configuration screen.
                                                  357
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS                                                                            B–63090EN/02
                                   NOTE
                                   1 This parameter is rewritten by the built–in macro data in
                                     FROM at power–up or at a reload operation.
                                   2 If the key of parameter No. 12013 is locked, the built–in
                                     macro data in FROM is used.
                                              358
B–63090EN/02                                                               4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
4.58
PARAMETERS OF
OPERATION
                              12801         Number of a signal symbol table for selecting an operation history signal (01)
HISTORY
                              12802         Number of a signal symbol table for selecting an operation history signal (02)
12803 Number of a signal symbol table for selecting an operation history signal (03)
12804 Number of a signal symbol table for selecting an operation history signal (04)
12805 Number of a signal symbol table for selecting an operation history signal (05)
12806 Number of a signal symbol table for selecting an operation history signal (06)
12807 Number of a signal symbol table for selecting an operation history signal (07)
12808 Number of a signal symbol table for selecting an operation history signal (08)
12809 Number of a signal symbol table for selecting an operation history signal (09)
12810 Number of a signal symbol table for selecting an operation history signal (10)
12811 Number of a signal symbol table for selecting an operation history signal (11)
12812 Number of a signal symbol table for selecting an operation history signal (12)
12813 Number of a signal symbol table for selecting an operation history signal (13)
12814 Number of a signal symbol table for selecting an operation history signal (14)
12815 Number of a signal symbol table for selecting an operation history signal (15)
12816 Number of a signal symbol table for selecting an operation history signal (16)
12817 Number of a signal symbol table for selecting an operation history signal (17)
12818 Number of a signal symbol table for selecting an operation history signal (18)
12819 Number of a signal symbol table for selecting an operation history signal (19)
12820 Number of a signal symbol table for selecting an operation history signal (20)
                                                    359
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS                                                                          B–63090EN/02
                                              360
B–63090EN/02                                               4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS
                         #7          #6         #5         #4         #3          #2      #1    #0
               12881     RB7         RB6        RB5        RB4        RB3         RB2     RB1   RB0
                                    361
4. DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETERS                                                                            B–63090EN/02
                                      #7          #6         #5         #4         #3          #2      #1     #0
                           12896      RB7         RB6        RB5        RB4        RB3         RB2     RB1    RB0
                                                 362
APPENDIX
B–63090EN/02                   APPENDIX                           A. CHARACTER CODE LIST
A 065 6 054
B 066 7 055
C 067 8 056
D 068 9 057
4 052 ^ 094
                                 365
B–63090EN/02                                                                                     Index
                         [C]                                  Parameters of Displaying Operation Time and Num-
                                                                ber of Parts, 292
 Character Code List, 365                                     Parameters of DNC1 Interface, 27, 29
                                                              Parameters of DNC1/DNC2 Interface, 20
                                                              Parameters of External Data Input/Output, 278
                         [D]                                  Parameters of Feedrate, 60
 Description of Parameters, 7                                 Parameters of Graphic Color, 290
 Displaying Parameters, 1                                     Parameters of Graphic Display, 288
                                                              Parameters of Graphic Display/Dynamic Graphic Dis-
                                                                play, 288
                         [I]                                  Parameters of High–Speed Machining (High–Speed
                                                                Cycle Machining/High–S peed Remote Buffer), 319
 Inputting and Outputting Parameters Through the
   Reader/Puncher Interface, 4                                Parameters of Indexing Index Table, 255
 Inputting Parameters through the Reader/Puncher In-          Parameters of M–NET Interface, 23
   terface, 6                                                 Parameters of Maintenance, 354
                                                              Parameters of Manual Handle Feed, Handle Interrup-
                                                                tion and Handle Feed in Tool Axial Direction, 308
                         [O]                                  Parameters of Manual Operation and Automatic Op-
                                                                eration, 306
 Other Parameters, 348
                                                              Parameters Of Mdi, Display, And Edit, 119
 Outputting Parameters through the Reader/Puncher             Parameters of Normal Direction Control, 252
  Interface, 5
                                                              Parameters of Online Custom Screen, 30
                                                              Parameters of Pattern Data Input, 265
                         [P]                                  Parameters of Peck Drilling Cycle of a Small Diame-
                                                                ter, 224
 Parameter of canned Cycle for Drilling, 216                  Parameters of Pitch Error Compensation, 155
 Parameter of Multiple Repetitive Canned Cycle, 222           Parameters of Polygon Turning, 321
 Parameter of Thread Cutting Cycle, 222                       Parameters of Position Switch Functions, 302
 Parameters Common to all Channels, 14                        Parameters of Positioning by Optimum Acceleration,
 Parameters of Acceleration/ Deceleration Control, 71           266
 Parameters of Angular Axis Control, 333                      Parameters of Power Motion Manager, 35
 Parameters of Automatic Tool Compensation (T Se-             Parameters of Programs, 146
   ries) and Automatic Tool Length Compensation (M            Parameters of reader/puncher interface, remote buffer,
   Series), 276                                                 dnc1, dnc2, and m–net interface, 13
 Parameters of Axis Control by PMC, 327                       Parameters of Reference Position Setting with Me-
                                                                chanical Stopper, 312
 Parameters of Axis Control/ Increment System, 36
                                                              Parameters of Rigid Tapping, 228
 Parameters of B–Axis Control, 335
                                                              Parameters of Scaling/Coordinate Rotation, 249
 Parameters of Canned Cycles, 216
                                                              Parameters of Servo, 87
 Parameters of Channel 1 (I/O CHANNEL=0), 15
                                                              Parameters of Setting , 9
 Parameters of Channel 1 (I/O CHANNEL=1), 16
                                                              Parameters of Simple Synchronous Control, 338
 Parameters of Channel 2 (I/O CHANNEL=2), 17
                                                              Parameters of Skip Function, 271
 Parameters of Channel 3 (I/O CHANNEL=3), 17
                                                              Parameters of Software Operator’s Panel, 314
 Parameters of Check Termination, 347
                                                              Parameters of Spindle Control, 166
 Parameters of Coordinates, 45
                                                              Parameters of Stroke Check, 51
 Parameters of Custom Macros, 257
                                                              Parameters of the Chuck and Tailstock Barrier (T Se-
 Parameters of Data Server, 32                                  ries), 56
 Parameters of Di/Do, 115                                     Parameters of Tool Compensation, 207
                                                        i–1
                                                 Index   B–63090EN/02
                       [S]
Setting Parameters from MDI, 2
                                                 i–2
                                                                              Revision Record
01 Apr., 1997